blob: 09e382fdd589726256e91b111e54bff79ab112d8 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Faulet9f971552022-05-13 17:13:48 +02006 2022/05/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013111. Address formats
13211.1. Address family prefixes
13311.2. Socket type prefixes
13411.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
1361. Quick reminder about HTTP
137----------------------------
138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
141on almost anything found in the contents.
142
143However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
144formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
145correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
146
147
1481.1. The HTTP transaction model
149-------------------------------
150
151The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100152to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100153from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
154connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155will involve a new connection :
156
157 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
158
159In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
160establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
161by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
162length.
163
164Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
165to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
166however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
167response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
168header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
169
170 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
171
172Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
173power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
174but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200175a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100177Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
179second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
180page :
181
182 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
183
184This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
185latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
186correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
187the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100188server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
191time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
192are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
193parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
194carry the stream identifier.
195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
197connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
198leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100199start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
200processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
201waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
205 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100206 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200208 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211
2121.2. HTTP request
213-----------------
214
215First, let's consider this HTTP request :
216
217 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
220 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
221 3 User-agent: my small browser
222 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
223 5 Accept: image/png
224
225
2261.2.1. The Request line
227-----------------------
228
229Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
230
231 - a METHOD : GET
232 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
234
235All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
236which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
237followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
238is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
239desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
240the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
241
242The URI itself can have several forms :
243
244 - A "relative URI" :
245
246 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
247
248 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
249 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
250
251 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
252
253 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
254
255 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
256 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
257 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
258 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
259 must accept this form too.
260
261 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
262 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
263 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200265 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
266 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
267 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
268 other protocols too.
269
270In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
271mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
272on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
273It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
274specific to the language, framework or application in use.
275
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100277assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200295as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
296normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
297representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
298HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400339over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400383 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
390 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
391 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
392
393The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3944.2).
395
396
3971.3.2. The response headers
398---------------------------
399
400Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
401the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
402details.
403
404
4052. Configuring HAProxy
406----------------------
407
4082.1. Configuration file format
409------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
411HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
412
413 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700415 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
419a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100420
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100421 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
422
423 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
424
425 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
426 tab characters
427
428 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
429 keyword sequences listed in this document
430
431 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
432 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
433 parts of the configuration, or expressions
434
435 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
436 are supported
437
438 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
439 section
440
441This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
442generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
443figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
444
445First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
446the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
447a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
448word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
449follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
450the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
451the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
452the parts that need to be addressed.
453
454A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
455requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
456extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
457the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
458section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
459section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
460not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
461
462A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
463each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
464a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
465start a new one.
466
467Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
468that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
469applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
470"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
471processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
472ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
473which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
474In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
475of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
476identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
477such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4782, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
479
480 listen foo
481 bind :80
482
483 listen bar
484 bind :81
485
486Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
487spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
488of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
489following configurations are strictly equivalent:
490
491 global#this is the global section
492 daemon#daemonize
493 frontend foo
494 mode http # or tcp
495
496and:
497
498 global
499 daemon
500
501 # this is the public web frontend
502 frontend foo
503 mode http
504
505The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
506new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
507other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
508section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
509section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
510at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
511
512Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
513are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
514editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
515support automatic indent.
516
517In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
518positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
519modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
520anymore, and is not recommended.
521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200522
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005232.2. Quoting and escaping
524-------------------------
525
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100526In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
527that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
528possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
529in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
530('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200531
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100532This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
533very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
534the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
535also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
536delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
537word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
538remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
541(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
542
543Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
544backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200545
546 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
547 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
548 \\ to use a backslash
549 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
550 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
551
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100552In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
553C-language representation:
554
555 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
556 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
557 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
558 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
559
560Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
561or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
562of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
566 # hash as a comment start
567
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100568Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
569evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
570dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
571backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
574character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
575is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
578entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
579name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
580represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
581hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
584 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
585 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
586 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
587 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
588 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
589 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
590 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
591 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
592 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
593 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594
595 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
599 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
602
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
604necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
605by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
606they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
607escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
608characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
609case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
610if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
611own quotes.
612
613The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600614quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500615not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
617
618Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
619arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
620
621 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
622 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
623
624Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
625"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
626cannot write:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629
630because we would like the string to cut like this:
631
632 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
633 |---------|----|-|
634 arg1 _/ / /
635 arg2 __________/ /
636 arg3 ______________/
637
638but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
639parenthesis then garbage:
640
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
642 |--------|--------|
643 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
644 trailing garbage _________/
645
646The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
647quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
648processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
649this word:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
652 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
653 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
654
655So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
656still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
657the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
658the second level:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
661 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
662 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
663 |---------||----|-|
664 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
665 arg2=blah ___________/ /
666 arg3=g _______________/
667
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500668Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100669double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
670
671 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
674 |---------||----|-|
675 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
676 arg2 ___________/ /
677 arg3 _______________/
678
679When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
680appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
681string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
682thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
683
684 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
685 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
686 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
687 |-------------| |-----||-|
688 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
689 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
690 arg3 ______________________/
691
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400692Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600693that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
695single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
696level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
697
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600698Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
699if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
700or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
701
702 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
705
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100706When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
707double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600708and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100709a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
710a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
711the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
712regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
713around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
714more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200715
716
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007172.3. Environment variables
718--------------------------
719
720HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
721interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
722configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
723optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
724shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200725underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
726list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
727arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
728before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729
730 Example:
731
732 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
733
734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
735
736 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
737
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200738Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
739file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200740
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200741* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
742 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
743
744* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
745 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
746 directory.
747
748* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
749
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500750* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200751 processes, separated by semicolons.
752
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500753* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200754 CLI, separated by semicolons.
755
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200756In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
757regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
758only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
759
760* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
761
762* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
763 starting at one.
764
765* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
766 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
767 first section.
768
769These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
770if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
771section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
772"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
773proxies.
774
775This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
776logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
777to name some config objects like servers for example.
778
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200780
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100781
7822.4. Conditional blocks
783-----------------------
784
785It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
786some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
787ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
788configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
789versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
790preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
791text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
792lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
793switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
794are defined to form conditional blocks:
795
796 - .if <condition>
797 - .elif <condition>
798 - .else
799 - .endif
800
801The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
802as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
803matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
804there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
805only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
806".elif" of a block.
807
808Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
809ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
810as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
811
812The conditions are currently limited to:
813
814 - an empty string, always returns "false"
815 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
816 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200817 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
818
819The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
820
821 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
822 exists, regardless of its contents
823
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200824 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
825 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
826 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
827
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200828 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
829 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
830
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200831 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
832 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
833 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
834 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
835
836 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200841Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200843 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
844 listen mwcli_px
845 bind :1111
846 ...
847 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100848
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200849 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
850 bind :80
851 .endif
852
853 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200854 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200855 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200856 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200857 .endif
858
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200859 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
860 profiling.memory on
861 .endif
862
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200863Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200865 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
867 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
868 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
869
870Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
871"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
872fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
873provide advice to the user.
874
875Example:
876
877 .if "${A}"
878 .if "${B}"
879 .notice "A=1, B=1"
880 .elif "${C}"
881 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
882 .elif "${D}"
883 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
884 .else
885 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
886 .endif
887 .else
888 .notice "A=0"
889 .endif
890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
892 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
893
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100894
8952.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200896----------------
897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100898Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100899values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
900otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
901numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
902for every keyword. Supported units are :
903
904 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
905 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
906 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
907 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
908 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
909 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
910
911
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009122.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200913-------------
914
915 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
916 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
917 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
918 global
919 daemon
920 maxconn 256
921
922 defaults
923 mode http
924 timeout connect 5000ms
925 timeout client 50000ms
926 timeout server 50000ms
927
928 frontend http-in
929 bind *:80
930 default_backend servers
931
932 backend servers
933 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
934
935
936 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
937 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
938 global
939 daemon
940 maxconn 256
941
942 defaults
943 mode http
944 timeout connect 5000ms
945 timeout client 50000ms
946 timeout server 50000ms
947
948 listen http-in
949 bind *:80
950 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
951
952
953Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
954
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100955 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200956
957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009583. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959--------------------
960
961Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
962are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
963of them have command-line equivalents.
964
965The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
966
967 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200968 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200970 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200971 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200973 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200974 - description
975 - deviceatlas-json-file
976 - deviceatlas-log-level
977 - deviceatlas-separator
978 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200979 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900980 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200981 - gid
982 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100983 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200984 - h1-case-adjust
985 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100986 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100987 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100988 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +0200989 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200990 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200991 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200992 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100993 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200994 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100995 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100996 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200997 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200999 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001001 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001003 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001004 - presetenv
1005 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - uid
1007 - ulimit-n
1008 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001009 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001010 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001011 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001012 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001014 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001015 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001016 - ssl-default-bind-options
1017 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001018 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - ssl-default-server-options
1020 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001021 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001022 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001023 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001025 - 51degrees-data-file
1026 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001027 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001028 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001029 - wurfl-data-file
1030 - wurfl-information-list
1031 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001032 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001033 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001036 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001037 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001039 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001040 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001041 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001042 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001043 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001044 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001045 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001046 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001047 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048 - noepoll
1049 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001050 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001052 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001053 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001054 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001055 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001056 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001057 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001058 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001059 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001060 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001061 - tune.buffers.limit
1062 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001063 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001064 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001065 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001066 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001067 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001068 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001069 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001070 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001071 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001072 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001073 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001074 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001075 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001076 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001077 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1078 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001079 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001080 - tune.maxaccept
1081 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001082 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001083 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001084 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001085 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1086 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001087 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1088 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001089 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001090 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001091 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001092 - tune.sndbuf.client
1093 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001094 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001095 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001096 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001097 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001098 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001099 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001100 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001101 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001102 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001103 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001104 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1105 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1106 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001107 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1108 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001112 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
1114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116------------------------------------
1117
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001118ca-base <dir>
1119 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001120 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1121 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1122 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001123
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124chroot <jail dir>
1125 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1126 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1127 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1128 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1129 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001130 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001131
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001132cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1133 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1134 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1135 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1136 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1137 set. These sets have the format
1138
1139 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1140
1141 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001142 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001143 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1144 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001145 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1146 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001147 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1148 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1149 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1150 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1151 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1152 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1153 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1154 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1155 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1156 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001157
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001158 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1159 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1160 on the machine's word size.
1161
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001162 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001163 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1164 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1165 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1166 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1167 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1168 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001169
1170 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001171 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1172
1173 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1174 # first 4 CPUs
1175
1176 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1177 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1178 # word size.
1179
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001180 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001181 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001182 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1183 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1184 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1185
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001186 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1187 # and so on.
1188 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1189 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1190 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001192 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001193 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1194 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1195 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1196
1197 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1198 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1199 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1200
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1202 # and a thread range.
1203 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1204 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1205 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1206
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001207crt-base <dir>
1208 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001209 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1210 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001211
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001212daemon
1213 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1214 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001215 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1216 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001218default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001219 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001220 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1221 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1222 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1223 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1224 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1225 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1226 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1227 not start with a slash ('/'):
1228 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1229 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1230
1231 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1232 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1233 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1234 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1235 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1236 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1237 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1238 each of them.
1239
1240 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1241 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1242 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1243 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1244 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1245 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1246 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1247 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1248
1249 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1250 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001251 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001252 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1253 made easily relocatable.
1254
1255 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1256 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1257 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1258 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1259 consistent across all configuration files.
1260
1261 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1262 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1263 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1264 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1265 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1266 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1267 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1268 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1269
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001270deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1271 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001272 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001273
1274deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001275 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001276 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1277
1278deviceatlas-separator <char>
1279 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1280 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1281
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001282deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001283 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1284 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1285 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001286
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001287expose-experimental-directives
1288 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1289 the config file will be rejected.
1290
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001291external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001292 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1293 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001294 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1295 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1296 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1297 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1298 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001300gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001301 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001302 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1303 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001304 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001305 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001307
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001308group <group name>
1309 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1310 See also "gid" and "user".
1311
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001312hard-stop-after <time>
1313 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1314
1315 Arguments :
1316 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1317 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1318 SIGUSR1 signal.
1319
1320 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1321 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1322 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1323
1324 Example:
1325 global
1326 hard-stop-after 30s
1327
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001328h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1329 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1330 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1331 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1332 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001333 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001334 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1335 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1336 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1337 specified in a proxy.
1338
1339 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1340 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1341 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1342 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1343 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1344 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1345 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1346
1347 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1348 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1349 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1350 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1351 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1352
1353 Example:
1354 global
1355 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1356
1357 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1358 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1359
1360h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1361 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1362 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1363 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1364 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1365 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1366 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1367 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1368 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1369
1370 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1371 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1372 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1373
1374 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1375 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1376
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001377insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001378 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001379 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1380 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1381 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1382 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1383 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1384 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1385 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001386 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001387 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1388 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1389 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1390 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1391 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1392 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1393 disable it.
1394
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001395insecure-setuid-wanted
1396 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1397 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1398 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1399 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001400 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001401 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001402 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001403 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1404 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001405 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001406 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1407 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1408 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1409 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1410
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001411issuers-chain-path <dir>
1412 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1413 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1414 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001415 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001416 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1417 "issuers-chain-path".
1418 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1419 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1420 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1421 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1422 will share the chain in memory.
1423
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001424h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1425 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1426 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1427 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1428 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1429 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1430 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1431 the keyword with "no'.
1432
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001433localpeer <name>
1434 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1435 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1436 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1437 the configuration parsing.
1438
1439 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1440 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1441
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001442log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001443 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001444 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001445 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001446 configured with "log global".
1447
1448 <address> can be one of:
1449
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001450 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001451 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1452 port).
1453
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001454 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1455 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1456 port).
1457
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001458 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001459 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1460 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001461 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001462
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001463 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1464 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1465 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1466 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1467 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1468 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1469 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1470 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1471 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1472 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001473 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001474 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1475 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1476 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001477 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1478 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001479
1480 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1481 "fd@2", see above.
1482
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001483 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1484 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1485 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1486 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1487 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1488
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001489 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1490 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001491
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001492 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1493 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1494 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1495 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1496 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1497 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1498 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1499 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1500 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1501 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001502 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1503 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001504
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001505 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1506 one of the following :
1507
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001508 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1509 field is stripped. This is the default.
1510 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1511 rfc3164.
1512
1513 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001514 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1515
1516 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1517 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1518
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001519 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1520 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1521 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1522 designed to be used with a local log server.
1523
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001524 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1525 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1526 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1527 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1528 logger consumes.
1529
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001530 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1531 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1532 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1533 used with a local log server.
1534
1535 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1536 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1537 designed to be used with a local log server.
1538
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001539 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1540 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1541 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1542 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1543
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001544 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1545 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1546 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1547 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1548 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1549
1550 <sample_size>
1551 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1552 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1553 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1554 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1555 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1556
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001557 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001558
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001559 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1560 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1561 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1562
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001563 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1564 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1565 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1566 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567
1568 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001569 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1570 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1571 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1572 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1573 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1574 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001575
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001576 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001577
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001578log-send-hostname [<string>]
1579 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1580 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1581 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1582 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1583 the logs.
1584
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001585log-tag <string>
1586 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1587 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1588 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001589 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001590
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001591lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001592 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1593 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1594 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1595 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1596 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1597 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001598 used multiple times.
1599
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001600lua-load-per-thread <file>
1601 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1602 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1603 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1604 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1605 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1606 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1607 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1608 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1609 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1610 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1611 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1612 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1613 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1614 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1615 times.
1616
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001617lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1618 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1619 variable.
1620 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1621 to "path".
1622
1623 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1624 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1625 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1626 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1627 will be checked earlier.
1628
1629 As an example by specifying the following path:
1630
1631 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1632 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1633
1634 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1635 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1636 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1637 paths if that does not exist either.
1638
1639 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1640 documentation.
1641
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001642master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001643 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1644 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1645 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001646 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001647 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1648 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001649 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1650 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1651 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1652 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1653 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001654
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001655 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001656
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001657mworker-max-reloads <number>
1658 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001659 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001660 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1661 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1662 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1663
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001664nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001665 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1666 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1667 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001668 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1669 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001670 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1671 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1672 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001673
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001674nbthread <number>
1675 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001676 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001677 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1678 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1679 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1680 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001681 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1682 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1683 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1684 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1685 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1686 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1687 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001688
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001689numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001690 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001691 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1692 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1693 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1694 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1695 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1696 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1697 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1698 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001700pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001701 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1702 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1703 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1704 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001706pp2-never-send-local
1707 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1708 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1709 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1710 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1711 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1712 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1713 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1714 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1715 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1716 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1717 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1718
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001719presetenv <name> <value>
1720 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1721 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1722 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1723 and "unsetenv".
1724
1725resetenv [<name> ...]
1726 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1727 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1728 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1729 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1730 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1731 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1732 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1733 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1734
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001735stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001736 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1737 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1738 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1739 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1740 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1741 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001742 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001743 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1744 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1745 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1746 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001747
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001748server-state-base <directory>
1749 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001750 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1751 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001752
1753server-state-file <file>
1754 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1755 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1756 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1757 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1758 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1759 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1760 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1761 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001762 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1763 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001764
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001765set-var <var-name> <expr>
1766 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1767 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1768 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1769 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1770 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1771 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1772 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1773 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1774 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1775
1776 Example:
1777 global
1778 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1779 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1780 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1781
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001782setenv <name> <value>
1783 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1784 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1785 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1786 and "unsetenv".
1787
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001788set-dumpable
1789 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001790 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1791 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1792 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1793 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1794 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1795 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1796 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1797 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1798 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1799 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1800 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1801 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1802 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1803 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1804 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001805 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001806 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001807
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001808ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1810 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001811 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001812 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001813 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1814 information and recommendations see e.g.
1815 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1816 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1817 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1818 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001819
1820ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1822 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1823 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1824 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1825 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001826 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1827 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1828 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001829 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001830
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001831ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1833 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1834 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1835 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1836 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1837
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001838ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1840 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1841 keyword to see available options.
1842
1843 Example:
1844 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001845 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001846
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001847ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1849 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001850 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001851 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001852 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1853 information and recommendations see e.g.
1854 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1855 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1856 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1857 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1858 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001859
1860ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1862 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1863 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1864 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1865 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001866 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1867 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1868 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1869 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001870
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001871ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1873 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1874 keyword to see available options.
1875
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001876ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1878 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1879 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001880 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001881 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001882 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1883 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1884 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1885 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001886 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1887 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1888 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1889
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001890ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1891 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1892 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001893 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001894 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001895 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1896
1897 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001898
1899 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1900 and won't try to remove them.
1901
1902 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1903
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001904ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001905 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001906 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1907 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1908 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001909
1910 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1911 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1912 optimize the startup time.
1913
1914 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1915 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1916 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1917
1918 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001919 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001920
1921 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001922 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1923 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001924
1925 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1926 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1927 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1928 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1929 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001930 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001931
1932 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001933 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001934 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1935 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1936 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1937 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1938 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001939 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001940
1941 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1942
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001943 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001944 a cert bundle.
1945
1946 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1947 separately in several "crt".
1948
1949 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1950 since files are loading separately.
1951
1952 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1953 required to commit them.
1954
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001955 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001956 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001957
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001958 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1959 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1960 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001961
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001962 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1963 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1964 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001965
1966 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001967 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1968 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001969
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001970 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1971 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1972
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001973 The default behavior is "all".
1974
1975 Example:
1976 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1977 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1978 ssl-load-extra-files none
1979
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001980 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1981 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001982
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001983ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1984 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1985 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1986 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1987
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001988ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001989 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001990 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1991 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1992 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1993 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1994 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1995 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001996 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001997
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001998stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1999 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2000 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2001 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002002 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002003 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002004
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002005 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2006 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2007 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002008
2009stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2010 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2011 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002012 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002013
2014stats maxconn <connections>
2015 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2016 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2017
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002018uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002019 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002020 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2021 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2022 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2023
2024ulimit-n <number>
2025 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2026 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2027 option.
2028
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002029unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2030 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2031
2032 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2033 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2034 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2035 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2036 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002037 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002038 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2039 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2040 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2041 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2042
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002043unsetenv [<name> ...]
2044 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2045 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2046 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2047 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2048 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2049 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2050 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2051
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002052user <user name>
2053 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2054 See also "uid" and "group".
2055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002056node <name>
2057 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2058
2059 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2060 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2061 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2062 traffic.
2063
2064description <text>
2065 Add a text that describes the instance.
2066
2067 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2068 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2069 "<" and ">" characters.
2070
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100207151degrees-data-file <file path>
2072 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002074
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002075 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002076 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2077
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000207851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002079 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2080 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2081 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2082
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002084 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2085
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200208651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002087 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2088 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2089
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002090 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002091 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2092
209351degrees-cache-size <number>
2094 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2095 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2096 By default, this cache is disabled.
2097
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002098 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002099 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2100
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002101wurfl-data-file <file path>
2102 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2103 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2104
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002105 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002106 with USE_WURFL=1.
2107
2108wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2109 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2110 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2111 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2112
2113 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2114
2115 Valid WURFL properties are:
2116 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2117
2118 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2119 device.
2120
2121 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2122 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2123
2124 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2125 particular web request.
2126
2127 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2128 used Libwurfl API version.
2129
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002130 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2131 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2132
2133 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2134 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2135
2136 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2137
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002138 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002139 with USE_WURFL=1.
2140
2141wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2142 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2143 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2144
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002146 with USE_WURFL=1.
2147
2148wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2149 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2150 thus before the chroot.
2151
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002152 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002153 with USE_WURFL=1.
2154
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002155wurfl-cache-size <size>
2156 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2157 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002158 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002159 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002160
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002161 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002162 with USE_WURFL=1.
2163
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002164strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002165 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002166 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2167 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002168 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002169 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021713.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002172-----------------------
2173
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002174busy-polling
2175 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2176 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2177 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2178 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2179 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2180 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2181 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2182 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2183 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2184 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2185 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2186 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2187 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2188 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2189 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2190 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2191 "poll" pollers.
2192
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002193 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2194 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2195 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2196
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002197max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002198 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002199 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2200 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2201 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2202 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2203 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2204 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2205 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2206
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002207maxconn <number>
2208 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2209 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2210 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002211 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2212 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2213 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2214 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002215 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2216 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2217 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2218 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2219 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2220 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002221
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002222maxconnrate <number>
2223 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2224 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2225 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2226 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2227 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2228 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2229 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2230 fairness.
2231
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002232maxcomprate <number>
2233 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002234 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002235 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2236 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2237 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002238 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002239 default value.
2240
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002241maxcompcpuusage <number>
2242 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2243 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2244 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002245 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. In
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002246 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2247 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2248 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2249 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2250
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002251maxpipes <number>
2252 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2253 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2254 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2255 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2256 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2257 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2258
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002259maxsessrate <number>
2260 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2261 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2262 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2263 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2264 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2265 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2266 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2267 fairness.
2268
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002269maxsslconn <number>
2270 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2271 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2272 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2273 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2274 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2275 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2276 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002277 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2278 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2279 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2280 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002281 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002282 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2283 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002284
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002285maxsslrate <number>
2286 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2287 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2288 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2289 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2290 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2291 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2292 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2293 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2294 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2295 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2296
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002297maxzlibmem <number>
2298 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2299 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2300 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002301 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2302 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2303 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2304
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002305no-memory-trimming
2306 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2307 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2308 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2309 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2310 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2311 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2312 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2313 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2314 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2315 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2316 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2317 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2318 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2319 not suffer from such a problem.
2320
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002321noepoll
2322 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2323 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002324 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002325
2326nokqueue
2327 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2328 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2329 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2330
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002331noevports
2332 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2333 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2334 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2335 also "nopoll".
2336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002337nopoll
2338 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2339 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002340 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002341 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2342 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002343
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002344nosplice
2345 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002346 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002347 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002348 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002349 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2350 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2351 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2352 "option splice-response".
2353
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002354nogetaddrinfo
2355 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2356 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2357
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002358noreuseport
2359 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2360 command line argument "-dR".
2361
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002362profiling.memory { on | off }
2363 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2364 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2365 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2366 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2367 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2368 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2369 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2370 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2371 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2372
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002373profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2374 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2375 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2376 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2377 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002378 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002379 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2380 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2381 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2382 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2383
2384 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2385 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2386 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2387 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2388 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002389 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2390 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2391 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2392 CLI.
2393
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002394spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002395 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2396 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2397 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2398 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2399 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2400 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002401
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002402ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002403 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002404 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002405 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002406 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002407 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2408 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2409 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002410 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2411 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002412 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2413 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2414 openssl configuration file uses:
2415 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2416
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002417ssl-mode-async
2418 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002419 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002420 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2421 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002422 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002423 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002424 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002425
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002426tune.buffers.limit <number>
2427 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2428 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2429 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2430 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2431 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002432 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002433 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2434 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2435 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2436 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2437 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2438 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2439 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2440 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002441 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002442
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002443tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2444 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2445 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2446 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002447 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002448
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002449tune.bufsize <number>
2450 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2451 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2452 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2453 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2454 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2455 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2456 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002457 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2458 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002459 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002460 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002461 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002462 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2463 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002464
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002465tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2466 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002467
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002468tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2469 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2470 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2471 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2472 this value. The default value is 1.
2473
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002474tune.fail-alloc
2475 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2476 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2477 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2478 gracefully.
2479
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002480tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2481 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2482 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2483 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2484 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2485 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2486
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002487tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2488 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2489 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2490 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2491 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2492 change it.
2493
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002494tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2495 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002496 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002497 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002498 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2499 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2500 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2501 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2502 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2503
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002504tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2505 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2506 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2507 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2508 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2509 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002510 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002511 recommended not to change this value.
2512
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002513tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002514 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002515 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002516 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002517 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2518 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2519 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2520 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2521
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002522tune.http.cookielen <number>
2523 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2524 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2525 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2526 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2527 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2528 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2529 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2530 to change this value.
2531
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002532tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002533 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2534 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002535 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002536 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002537 configuration directives too.
2538 The default value is 1024.
2539
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002540tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2541 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2542 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2543 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2544 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2545 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2546 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002547 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2548 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2549 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002550
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002551tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2552 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2553 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2554 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2555 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2556 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2557 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002558 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2559 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2560 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2561 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2562 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002563
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002564tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002565 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002566 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2567 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2568 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2569 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002570 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002571 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002572 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002573 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2574
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002575tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2576 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2577 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2578 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2579 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2580 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2581 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2582 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2583 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2584 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2585
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002586tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2587 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002588 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002589 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2590 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002591 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002592 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2593 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2594
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002595tune.lua.maxmem
2596 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2597 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2598 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2599 memory.
2600
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002601tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2602 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002603 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2604 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002605 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002606
2607tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2608 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2609 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2610 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2611 check servers.
2612
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002613tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2614 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2615 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2616 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002617 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002618
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002619tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002620 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2621 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002622 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2623 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2624 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2625 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2626 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2627 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2628 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2629 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2630 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002631
2632tune.maxpollevents <number>
2633 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2634 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2635 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2636 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2637 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2638
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002639tune.maxrewrite <number>
2640 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2641 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2642 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2643 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2644 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2645 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2646 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2647 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2648 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2649 bufsize.
2650
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002651tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2652 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2653 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2654 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2655 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2656 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2657 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2658 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2659 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2660 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002661 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2662 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002663 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2664 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2665 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2666 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2667 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2668 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2669 setting this parameter to 0.
2670
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002671tune.pipesize <number>
2672 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2673 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2674 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2675 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2676 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2677 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2678
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002679tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2680 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002681 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002682 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2683 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2684 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2685 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002686 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002687
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002688tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2689 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002690 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002691 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2692 default is 20.
2693
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002694tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2695tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2696 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2697 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2698 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002699 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002700 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002701 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2702 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2703
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002704tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002705 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002706 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2707 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2708 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2709 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2710
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002711tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002712 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002713 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2714 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2715 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2716 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2717 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2718 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2719 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002720
2721tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2722 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002723 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002724 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2725 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2726 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2727 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2728 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2729 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2730 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002731
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002732tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2733tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2734 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2735 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2736 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002737 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002738 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002739 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2740 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2741 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2742 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002743 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002744
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002745tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002746 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002747 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2748 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2749 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2750 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2751 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2752 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2753 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2754 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2755 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2756 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2757 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002758
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002759tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002760 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002761 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2762 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2763 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2764 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2765 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2766
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002767tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2768 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2769 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2770 performances. This is disabled by default.
2771
2772 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2773 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2774
2775 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2776
2777 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2778
2779 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2780
2781 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2782 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2783 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2784
2785 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2786 converted.
2787
2788 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2789 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2790 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2791 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2792 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2793 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2794 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002795 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2796 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002797
2798 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2799
2800 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2801 only need this line:
2802
2803 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2804
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002805tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2806 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002807 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002808 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2809 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2810 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2811 being used for too long.
2812
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002813tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2814 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2815 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2816 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2817 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2818 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2819 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2820 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2821 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2822 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2823 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002824 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002825 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002826
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002827tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2828 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2829 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2830 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2831 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002832 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002833 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2834 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002835 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2836 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002837
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002838tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2839 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2840 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2841 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2842 1000 entries.
2843
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002844tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2845 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2846 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2847 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2848
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002849tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002850tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002851tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2852tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2853tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002854 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2855 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2856 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2857 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2858 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2859 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2860 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2861 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002862
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002863 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2864 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2865 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2866 all available space is consumed.
2867 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2868 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2869 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002870
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002871tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2872 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002873 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002874 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002875 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002876 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2877
2878tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2879 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2880 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002881 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2882 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028843.3. Debugging
2885--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002886
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002887quiet
2888 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2889 line argument "-q".
2890
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002891zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002892 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002893 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2894 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2895 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2896 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2897 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2898
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029003.4. Userlists
2901--------------
2902It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2903http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2904it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2905
2906userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002907 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002908 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2909
2910group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002911 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002912 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2913 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2914
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002915user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2916 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2918 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002919 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2920 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2921 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2922 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002923
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002924 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2925 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2926 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2927 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2928 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2929 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2930 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002931 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002932 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002933
2934 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002935 userlist L1
2936 group G1 users tiger,scott
2937 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002938
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002939 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2940 user scott insecure-password elgato
2941 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002942
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002943 userlist L2
2944 group G1
2945 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002946
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002947 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2948 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2949 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002950
2951 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002952
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002953
29543.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002955----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002956It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002957several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002958instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2959values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2960automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2961In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2962using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2963tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2964reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2965Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2966that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2967each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002968
2969peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002970 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002971 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2972
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002973bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2974 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2975 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2976
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002977disabled
2978 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2979 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2980 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2981
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002982default-bind [param*]
2983 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2984
2985default-server [param*]
2986 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2987
2988 Arguments:
2989 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2990 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02002991 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
2992 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
2993 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
2994 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002995
2996 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2997
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02002998enabled
2999 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3000 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003001
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003002log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003003 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3004 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3005 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3006 more details.
3007
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003008peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003009 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3010 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003011 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003012 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003013 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3014 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3015 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003016
3017 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3018 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3019
3020 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003021 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3022 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3023 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003024
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003025 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3026 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003027
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003028 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3029 "server" keyword explanation below).
3030
3031server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003032 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003033 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3034 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3035 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3036 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003037
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003038 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3039 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3040 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3041 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3042 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003043
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003044 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003045 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003046 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003047 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3048 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3049 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003050
3051 backend mybackend
3052 mode tcp
3053 balance roundrobin
3054 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3055 stick on src
3056
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003057 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3058 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003059
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003060 Example:
3061 peers mypeers
3062 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3063 default-server ssl verify none
3064 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3065 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003066
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003067
3068table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3069 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3070
3071 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3072 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003073 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003074 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3075 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3076 "stick-table" keyword).
3077
3078 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3079 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3080 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3081 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3082 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3083 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3084 of the stick-table name as follows:
3085
3086 peers mypeers
3087 peer A ...
3088 peer B ...
3089 table t1 ...
3090
3091 frontend fe1
3092 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3093
3094 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3095 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3096
3097 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3098 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3099 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3100 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3101 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3102 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3103 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3104
3105 peers mypeers
3106 peer A ...
3107 peer B ...
3108 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3109
3110 backend t1
3111 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3112
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003113 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003114 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3115 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3116
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031173.6. Mailers
3118------------
3119It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3120If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3121in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3122
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003123mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003124 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3125 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3126
3127mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3128 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3129
3130 Example:
3131 mailers mymailers
3132 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3133 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3134
3135 backend mybackend
3136 mode tcp
3137 balance roundrobin
3138
3139 email-alert mailers mymailers
3140 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3141 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3142
3143 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3144 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3145
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003146timeout mail <time>
3147 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3148 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3149 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3150 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3151
3152 Example:
3153 mailers mymailers
3154 timeout mail 20s
3155 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003156
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031573.7. Programs
3158-------------
3159In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3160master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3161managed the same way as the workers.
3162
3163During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3164sequence as a worker:
3165
3166 - the master is re-executed
3167 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3168 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3169 instance of the program
3170
3171During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3172
3173program <name>
3174 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3175 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3176 the management guide).
3177
3178command <command> [arguments*]
3179 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3180 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3181 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3182 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3183
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003184user <user name>
3185 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3186 See also "group".
3187
3188group <group name>
3189 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3190 See also "user".
3191
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003192option start-on-reload
3193no option start-on-reload
3194 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3195 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3196 program section.
3197
3198
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031993.8. HTTP-errors
3200----------------
3201
3202It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3203imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3204several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3205
3206http-errors <name>
3207 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3208 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3209
3210errorfile <code> <file>
3211 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3212
3213 Arguments :
3214 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003215 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003216 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003217
3218 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3219 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3220 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3221 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3222 before any chroot is performed.
3223
3224 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3225
3226 Example:
3227 http-errors website-1
3228 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3229 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3230 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3231
3232 http-errors website-2
3233 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3234 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3235 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3236
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032373.9. Rings
3238----------
3239
3240It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3241servers or traces.
3242
3243ring <ringname>
3244 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3245
3246description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003247 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003248 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3249
3250format <format>
3251 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3252
3253 Arguments:
3254 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3255 one of the following :
3256
3257 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3258 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3259 designed to be used with a local log server.
3260
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003261 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3262 field is stripped. This is the default.
3263 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3264 rfc3164.
3265
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003266 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3267 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3268 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3269 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3270 is the default.
3271
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003272 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003273 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3274
3275 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3276 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3277
3278 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3279 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3280 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3281 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3282 logger consumes.
3283
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003284 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3285 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3286 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3287 with a local log server.
3288
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003289 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3290 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3291 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3292 used with a local log server.
3293
3294maxlen <length>
3295 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3296 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3297 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3298
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003299server <name> <address> [param*]
3300 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3301 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3302 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3303 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3304 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3305 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3306 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3307 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3308 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003309 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3310 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003311
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003312size <size>
3313 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3314 set to BUFSIZE.
3315
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003316timeout connect <timeout>
3317 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3318
3319 Arguments :
3320 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3321 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3322 as explained at the top of this document.
3323
3324timeout server <timeout>
3325 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3326
3327 Arguments :
3328 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3329 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3330 as explained at the top of this document.
3331
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003332 Example:
3333 global
3334 log ring@myring local7
3335
3336 ring myring
3337 description "My local buffer"
3338 format rfc3164
3339 maxlen 1200
3340 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003341 timeout connect 5s
3342 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003343 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003344
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033453.10. Log forwarding
3346-------------------
3347
3348It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003349HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003350
3351log-forward <name>
3352 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3353
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003354backlog <conns>
3355 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3356 on connections accept.
3357
3358bind <addr> [param*]
3359 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003360 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3361 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3362 syslog protocol over TCP.
3363 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003364 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3365
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003366dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003367 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3368 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3369 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3370 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003371 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003372
3373log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003374log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003375 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3376 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3377 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003378 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003379 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3380 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3381 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003382 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003383
3384 Example:
3385 global
3386 log stderr format iso local7
3387
3388 ring myring
3389 description "My local buffer"
3390 format rfc5424
3391 maxlen 1200
3392 size 32764
3393 timeout connect 5s
3394 timeout server 10s
3395 # syslog tcp server
3396 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3397
3398 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003399 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3400 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003401 # all messages on stderr
3402 log global
3403 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3404 log ring@myring local0
3405 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3406 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3407 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3408 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3409 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003410
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003411maxconn <conns>
3412 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3413 10 is the default.
3414
3415timeout client <timeout>
3416 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034184. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003419----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003421Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003422 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3423 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3424 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3425 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003426
3427A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3428connections.
3429
3430A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3431to forward incoming connections.
3432
3433A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3434parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3435
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003436A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3437ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3438sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3439the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3440explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3441from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3442"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3443for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3444to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3445optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3446are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3447any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3448names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3449that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3450duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3451names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3452
3453Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3454settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3455of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3456profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3457timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003459All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3460'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3461case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3462
3463Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3464logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3465proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3466However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3467name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3468
3469Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3470and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003471bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003472protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3473modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3474arbitrary criteria.
3475
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003476In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3477a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003478the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003479
3480 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3481 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3482 between responses and new requests.
3483
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003484 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3485 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3486 client-facing connection remains open.
3487
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003488 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3489 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003490
3491The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3492frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3493following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003494weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003495
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003496 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003497
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003498 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3499 ----+-----+-----+----
3500 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3501 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003502 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3503 ----+-----+-----+----
3504 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003505
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003506It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003507only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3508within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003509as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003510content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003511and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3512possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003513
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003514There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003515first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003516processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003517second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003518protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3519is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3520new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003521to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003522process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3523already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3524HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3525evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3526one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3527
3528There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3529performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3530tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3531preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3532analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3533HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3534header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3535mitigate this drawback.
3536
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003537There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003538method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3539set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3540in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3541is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3542to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3543above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3544to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3545"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3546frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3547frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3548as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3549upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3550on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3551the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3552upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3553frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3554remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3557--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003558
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003559The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3560limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3561they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3562limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003563marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003564option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003565and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3566with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3567specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003568
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003569
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003570 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3571------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3572acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003573backlog X X X -
3574balance X - X X
3575bind - X X -
3576bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003577capture cookie - X X -
3578capture request header - X X -
3579capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003580clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3581clitcpka-idle X X X -
3582clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003583compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003584cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003585declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003586default-server X - X X
3587default_backend X X X -
3588description - X X X
3589disabled X X X X
3590dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003591email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003592email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003593email-alert mailers X X X X
3594email-alert myhostname X X X X
3595email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003596enabled X X X X
3597errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003598errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003599errorloc X X X X
3600errorloc302 X X X X
3601-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3602errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003603force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003604filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605fullconn X - X X
3606grace X X X X
3607hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003608http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003609http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003610http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003611http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003612http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003613http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003614http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003615http-check set-var X - X X
3616http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003617http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003618http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003619http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003620http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003621http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003622id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003623ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003624load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003625log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003626log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003627log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003628log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003629max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003630maxconn X X X -
3631mode X X X X
3632monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003633monitor-uri X X X -
3634option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3635option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3636option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3637option allbackups (*) X - X X
3638option checkcache (*) X - X X
3639option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3640option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003641option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003642option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3643option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003644-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3645option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003646option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3647option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003648option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003649option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003650option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003651option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003652option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003653option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3655option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3656option httpchk X - X X
3657option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003658option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003659option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003660option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003661option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003662option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003663option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3664option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3665option logasap (*) X X X -
3666option mysql-check X - X X
3667option nolinger (*) X X X X
3668option originalto X X X X
3669option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003670option pgsql-check X - X X
3671option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003672option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003673option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003674option smtpchk X - X X
3675option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3676option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3677option splice-request (*) X X X X
3678option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003679option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003680option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3681option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3682-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003683option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003684option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3685option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3686option tcpka X X X X
3687option tcplog X X X X
3688option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003689option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003690external-check command X - X X
3691external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003692persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3693rate-limit sessions X X X -
3694redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003695-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003697retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003698server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003699server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003700server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003702srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3703srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3704srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003705stats admin - X X X
3706stats auth X X X X
3707stats enable X X X X
3708stats hide-version X X X X
3709stats http-request - X X X
3710stats realm X X X X
3711stats refresh X X X X
3712stats scope X X X X
3713stats show-desc X X X X
3714stats show-legends X X X X
3715stats show-node X X X X
3716stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003717-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3718stick match - - X X
3719stick on - - X X
3720stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003721stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003722stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003723tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003724tcp-check connect X - X X
3725tcp-check expect X - X X
3726tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003727tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003728tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003729tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003730tcp-check set-var X - X X
3731tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003732tcp-request connection - X X -
3733tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003734tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003735tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003736tcp-response content - - X X
3737tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003738timeout check X - X X
3739timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003740timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003741timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003742timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3743timeout http-request X X X X
3744timeout queue X - X X
3745timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003746timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003747timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003748timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003749transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003750unique-id-format X X X -
3751unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003752use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003753use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003754use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003755------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3756 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003757
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037594.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3760---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003761
3762This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3763
3764
3765acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3766 Declare or complete an access list.
3767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3768 no | yes | yes | yes
3769 Example:
3770 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3771 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3772 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003774 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003775
3776
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003777backlog <conns>
3778 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3780 yes | yes | yes | no
3781 Arguments :
3782 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3783 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003784 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003785
3786 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3787 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3788 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3789 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3790 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3791 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3792 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3793 backlog parameter.
3794
3795 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3796 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3797 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3798
3799 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3800
3801
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003802balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003803balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003804 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3806 yes | no | yes | yes
3807 Arguments :
3808 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3809 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3810 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3811 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3812
3813 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3814 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3815 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3816 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003817 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003818 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003819 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3820 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3821 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3822 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3823 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3824 it, so that you don't worry.
3825
3826 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3827 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3828 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3829 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3830 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3831 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3832 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3833 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003834
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003835 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3836 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3837 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3838 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3839 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3840 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3841 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003842 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3843 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3844 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003845
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003846 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003847 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003848 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3849 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003850 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003851 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3852 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3853 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3854 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3855 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003856 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3857 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3858 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3859 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3860 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3861 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003863 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3864 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3865 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3866 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3867 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3868 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3869 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3870 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003871 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003872 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003873 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3874 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3875 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003876
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003877 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3878 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3879 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3880 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3881 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3882 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3883 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3884 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3885 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3886 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3887 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3888 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003889
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003890 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003891 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3892 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3893 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3894 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3895 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3896 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3897 URIs start with a leading "/".
3898
3899 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3900 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3901 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3902 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3903
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003904 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3905 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3906 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3907 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3908
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003909 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003910 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3911
3912 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003913 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3914 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003915 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3916 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3917 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3918 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003919 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003920 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3921 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003922
3923 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3924 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3925 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3926 server will receive the request.
3927
3928 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3929 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3930 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3931 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3932 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003933 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3934 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3935 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003936
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003937 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3938 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3939 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3940 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3941 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003943 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003944 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3945 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3946 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3947
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003948 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3949 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3950 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3951
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003952 random
3953 random(<draws>)
3954 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003955 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3956 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3957 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3958 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003959 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3960 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3961 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3962 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3963 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3964 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3965 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3966 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3967 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3968 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3969 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3970 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3971 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3972 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3973 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3974 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3975 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3976 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3977 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3978 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003979
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003980 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003981 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003982 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3983 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003984 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003985 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3986 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3987 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003988 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003989 used instead.
3990
3991 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3992 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3993 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003994 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003995
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003996 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3997 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3998 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004000 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004001 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4002 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004003
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004004 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4005 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4006 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004007
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004008 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004009 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004010 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4011 NTLM relies on.
4012
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004013 Examples :
4014 balance roundrobin
4015 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004016 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004017 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4018 balance hdr(host)
4019 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004020
4021 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4022 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004024 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004025 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4026 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4027 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004028 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004029
4030 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4031 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4032 defaults to 16 kB.
4033
4034 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4035 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4036
4037 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4038 Round Robin.
4039
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004040 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004041 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4042 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4043 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4044
4045 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4046
4047 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004048 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004049 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4050 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4051 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004052
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004053 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004054
4055
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004056bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4057bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4060 no | yes | yes | no
4061 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004062 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4063 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4064 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4065 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004066 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004067 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4068 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4069 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4070 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4071 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4072 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004073 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004074 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4075 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004076 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004077 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4078 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004079 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004080 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4081 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004082 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004083 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4084 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4085 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4086 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4087 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4088 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4089 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004090 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4091 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4092 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004093 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4094 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4095 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4096 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004097 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4098 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4099 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004100
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004101 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4102 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004103 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4104 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4105 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004106 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4107 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4108 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4109 the range.
4110
4111 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4112 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4113 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4114 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4115 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4116 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4117 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004118 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004119 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004120
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004121 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004122 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004123 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4124 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4125 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4126 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4127 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4128 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4129
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004130 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4131 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4132 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4133 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004135 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4136 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4137 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4138 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4139 in a frontend.
4140
4141 Example :
4142 listen http_proxy
4143 bind :80,:443
4144 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004145 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004146
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004147 listen http_https_proxy
4148 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004149 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004150
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004151 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4152 bind ipv6@:80
4153 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4154 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4155
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004156 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004157 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004158
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004159 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4160 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4161 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4162 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4163 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4164
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004165 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004166 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004167
4168
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004169bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004170 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4172 yes | yes | yes | yes
4173 Arguments :
4174 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4175 may be used to override a default value.
4176
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004177 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004178 option may be combined with other numbers.
4179
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004180 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004181 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4182 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4183 missing from all processes.
4184
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004185 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004186 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004187 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4188 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4189 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4190 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4191 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004192 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004193
4194 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4195 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4196 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4197 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4198 and 'even' instances.
4199
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004200 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4201 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4202 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4203 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004204
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004205 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4206 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4207
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004208 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4209 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4210 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4211
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004212 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4213 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4214
4215 Example :
4216 listen app_ip1
4217 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004218 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004219
4220 listen app_ip2
4221 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004222 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004223
4224 listen management
4225 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004226 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004227
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004228 listen management
4229 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4230 bind-process 1-4
4231
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004232 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004233
4234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004235capture cookie <name> len <length>
4236 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4238 no | yes | yes | no
4239 Arguments :
4240 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4241 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4242 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4243 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004244 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004245
4246 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4247 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4248 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4249 right if it exceeds <length>.
4250
4251 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4252 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4253 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4254 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4255
4256 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4257 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4258 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4259
4260 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4261 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4262 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004263 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4264 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4265 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004266
4267 Example:
4268 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4269
4270 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004271 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004272
4273
4274capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004275 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4277 no | yes | yes | no
4278 Arguments :
4279 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004280 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004281 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4282 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4283 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4284
4285 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4286 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4287 it exceeds <length>.
4288
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004289 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004290 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4291 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004292 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4293 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4294 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4295 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004296 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004297 environments to find where the request came from.
4298
4299 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4300 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4301 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4302 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004303
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004304 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4305 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4306 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4307 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4308 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309
4310 Example:
4311 capture request header Host len 15
4312 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004313 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004315 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004316 about logging.
4317
4318
4319capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004320 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4322 no | yes | yes | no
4323 Arguments :
4324 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004325 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004326 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4327 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4328 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4329
4330 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4331 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4332 it exceeds <length>.
4333
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004334 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004335 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4336 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4337 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004338 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4339 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4340 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4341 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004342
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004343 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4344 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4345 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4346 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4347 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348
4349 Example:
4350 capture response header Content-length len 9
4351 capture response header Location len 15
4352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004353 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004354 about logging.
4355
4356
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004357clitcpka-cnt <count>
4358 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4359 the connection on the client side.
4360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4361 yes | yes | yes | no
4362 Arguments :
4363 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4364
4365 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4366 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004367 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4368 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004369
4370 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4371
4372
4373clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4374 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4375 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4376 client side.
4377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4378 yes | yes | yes | no
4379 Arguments :
4380 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4381 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4382 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4383 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4384
4385 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4386 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004387 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4388 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004389
4390 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4391
4392
4393clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4394 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4396 yes | yes | yes | no
4397 Arguments :
4398 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4399 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4400 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4401 document.
4402
4403 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4404 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004405 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4406 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004407
4408 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4409
4410
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004411compression algo <algorithm> ...
4412compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004413compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004414 Enable HTTP compression.
4415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4416 yes | yes | yes | yes
4417 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004418 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4419 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004420 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004421
4422 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004423 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4424 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4425 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004426
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004427 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004428 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004429
4430 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4431 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4432 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4433 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4434 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004435 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004436
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004437 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4438 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4439 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4440 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4441 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4442 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4443 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004444 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004445
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004446 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004447 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004448 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004449 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004450 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004451 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004452 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004453
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004454 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004455 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4456 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004457 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4458 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004459 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004460 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004461 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4462 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004463 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004464 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4465 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004466
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004467 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004468 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4469 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004470 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004471 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004472 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4473 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4474 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4475 "multipart"
4476 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4477 header
4478 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4479 and later
4480 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4481 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004482 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004483
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004484 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004485
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004486 Examples :
4487 compression algo gzip
4488 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004489
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004490
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004491cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004492 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4493 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004494 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004495 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4497 yes | no | yes | yes
4498 Arguments :
4499 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4500 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4501 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4502 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4503 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4504 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004505 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004506 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4507 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4508
4509 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004510 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004511 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4512 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4513 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4514 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004515 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4516 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004517 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004518 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4519 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004520
4521 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004522 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004523
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004524 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004525 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004526 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004527 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004528 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4529 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4530 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4531 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4532 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4533 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4534 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004535
4536 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4537 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4538 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4539 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4540 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4541 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4542 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4543 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4544 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004545 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004546 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4547 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4548 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004549
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004550 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4551 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4552 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004553 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4554 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4555 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4556 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004557 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4558 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4559 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004560
4561 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4562 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4563 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4564 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4565 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4566 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4567 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4568 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4569 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4570
4571 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4572 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4573 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4574 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4575 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4576 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4577 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4578 persistence cookie in the cache.
4579 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4580
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004581 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4582 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004583 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004584 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4585 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004586 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004587 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4588 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4589 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4590 they logout.
4591
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004592 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004593 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4594 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4595 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4596
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004597 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004598 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4599 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4600 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4601 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4602 this attribute.
4603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004604 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004605 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004606 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4607 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4608 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4609 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4610 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4611 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004612
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004613 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4614 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4615 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4616 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4617 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4618 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4619 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4620 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004621 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004622 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4623 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4624 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4625 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4626 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4627 the site.
4628
4629 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4630 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4631 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4632 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4633 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4634 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4635 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4636 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4637 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4638 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4639 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4640 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4641 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004642 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004643 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4644 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4645
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004646 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4647 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4648 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4649 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4650 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4651 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4652
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004653 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004654 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4655 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4656 repeated.
4657
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004658 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4659 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4660 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4661 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004662
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004663 Examples :
4664 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4665 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4666 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004667 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004668
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004669 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004670
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004671
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004672declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4673 Declares a capture slot.
4674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4675 no | yes | yes | no
4676 Arguments:
4677 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4678
4679 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4680 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4681 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4682 for use in the response.
4683
4684 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004685 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004686 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4687
4688
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004689default-server [param*]
4690 Change default options for a server in a backend
4691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4692 yes | no | yes | yes
4693 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004694 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4695 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4696 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4697 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004698
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004699 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004700 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4701
4702 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004703
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004704
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004705default_backend <backend>
4706 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 yes | yes | yes | no
4709 Arguments :
4710 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4711
4712 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4713 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4714 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4715 will catch all undetermined requests.
4716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004717 Example :
4718
4719 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4720 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4721 default_backend dynamic
4722
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004723 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004724
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004725
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004726description <string>
4727 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4729 no | yes | yes | yes
4730 Arguments : string
4731
4732 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4733 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4734 it describes.
4735 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4736
4737
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004738disabled
4739 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4741 yes | yes | yes | yes
4742 Arguments : none
4743
4744 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4745 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4746 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4747 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4748 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4749 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4750 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4751
4752 See also : "enabled"
4753
4754
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004755dispatch <address>:<port>
4756 Set a default server address
4757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004759 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004760
4761 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4762 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4763 during start-up.
4764
4765 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4766 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4767 possible with normal servers.
4768
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004769 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004770 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4771 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4772 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4773 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4774
4775 See also : "server"
4776
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004777
4778dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4779 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4781 yes | no | yes | yes
4782 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4783
4784 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004785 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004786 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4787 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004788 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004789 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004791enabled
4792 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4794 yes | yes | yes | yes
4795 Arguments : none
4796
4797 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4798 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4799
4800 See also : "disabled"
4801
4802
4803errorfile <code> <file>
4804 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4806 yes | yes | yes | yes
4807 Arguments :
4808 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004809 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004810 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004811
4812 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004813 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004814 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004815 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4816 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004817
4818 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4819 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4820 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4821
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004822 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4823
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004824 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4825 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4826 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4827 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4828 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4829 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4830 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4831 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4832 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004834 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4835 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4836 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004837 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004838 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4839
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004840 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004841
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004842 Example :
4843 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004844 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004845 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4846 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4847
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004848
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004849errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4850 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4851 section.
4852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4853 yes | yes | yes | yes
4854 Arguments :
4855 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4856
4857 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004858 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004859 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4860 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004861
4862 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4863 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4864 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4865 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4866 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004867 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004868 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4869
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004870 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4871 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004872
4873 Example :
4874 errorfiles generic
4875 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4876
4877
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004878errorloc <code> <url>
4879errorloc302 <code> <url>
4880 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4882 yes | yes | yes | yes
4883 Arguments :
4884 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004885 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004886 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004887
4888 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4889 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4890 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4891 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004892 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004893
4894 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4895 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4896 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4897
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004898 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4899
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004900 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4901 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4902 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4903 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004904 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004905 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4906 request.
4907
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004908 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004909
4910
4911errorloc303 <code> <url>
4912 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | yes
4915 Arguments :
4916 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004917 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004918 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919
4920 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4921 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4922 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4923 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004924 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004925
4926 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4927 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4928 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4929
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004930 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4931
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004932 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4933 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4934 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4935 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004936 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004937
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004938 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004939
4940
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004941email-alert from <emailaddr>
4942 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004943 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004944 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4945 yes | yes | yes | yes
4946
4947 Arguments :
4948
4949 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4950
4951 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4952 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4953
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004954 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004955 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4956 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004957
4958
4959email-alert level <level>
4960 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4961 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | yes | yes | yes
4964
4965 Arguments :
4966
4967 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4968 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4969 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4970
4971 By default level is alert
4972
4973 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4974 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4975 for the proxy.
4976
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004977 Alerts are sent when :
4978
4979 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4980 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4981 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4982 is notice or lower
4983 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4984 and a health check status update occurs
4985
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004986 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4987 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004988 section 3.6 about mailers.
4989
4990
4991email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4992 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4994 yes | yes | yes | yes
4995
4996 Arguments :
4997
4998 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4999
5000 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5001 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5002
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005003 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5004 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005005
5006
5007email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5008 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5009 mailers.
5010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5011 yes | yes | yes | yes
5012
5013 Arguments :
5014
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005015 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005016
5017 By default the systems hostname is used.
5018
5019 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5020 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5021 for the proxy.
5022
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005023 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5024 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005025
5026
5027email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005028 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005029 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5030 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5031 yes | yes | yes | yes
5032
5033 Arguments :
5034
5035 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5036
5037 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5038 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5039
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005040 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005041 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5042
5043
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005044force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5045 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5046 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005047 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005048
5049 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5050 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5051 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5052 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5053 marked down for maintenance operations.
5054
5055 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5056 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5057 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5058 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5059 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5060 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5061 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5062 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5063 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5064
5065 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5066 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5067 is used.
5068
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005069 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005070 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005071
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005072
5073filter <name> [param*]
5074 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5076 no | yes | yes | yes
5077 Arguments :
5078 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5079 referenced in section 9.
5080
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005081 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005082 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005083 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5084 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005085
5086 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5087 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5088
5089 Example:
5090 listen
5091 bind *:80
5092
5093 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5094 filter compression
5095 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5096
5097 compression algo gzip
5098 compression offload
5099
5100 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5101
5102 See also : section 9.
5103
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005104
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005105fullconn <conns>
5106 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5108 yes | no | yes | yes
5109 Arguments :
5110 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5111 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5112
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005113 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005114 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005115 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005116 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5117 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5118 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5119 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5120 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005121 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005123 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005124 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005125 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5126 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5127 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005128
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005129 Example :
5130 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5131 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5132 # connections.
5133 backend dynamic
5134 fullconn 10000
5135 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5136 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5137
5138 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5139
5140
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005141grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005142 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005144 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005145 Arguments :
5146 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5147 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5148 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5149
5150 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5151 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005152 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005153 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5154
5155 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5156 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5157 simplify it.
5158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005159
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005160hash-balance-factor <factor>
5161 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5163 yes | no | no | yes
5164 Arguments :
5165 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5166 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005167 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005168
5169 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5170 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5171 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5172 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5173 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5174 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5175 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5176
5177 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5178 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5179 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5180 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5181 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5182
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005183 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5184 consistent hashing mechanism.
5185
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005186 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5187
5188
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005189hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005190 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5192 yes | no | yes | yes
5193 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005194 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5195 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005196
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005197 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5198 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5199 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5200 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5201 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5202 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5203 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5204 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5205 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5206 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005207
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005208 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5209 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5210 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5211 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5212 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5213 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5214 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5215 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5216 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5217 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5218 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5219 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5220 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005221 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5222 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005223
5224 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5225
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005226 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005227 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5228 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5229 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005230 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5231 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5232 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005233
5234 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5235 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005236 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5237 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5238 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5239 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5240
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005241 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005242 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5243 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5244 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5245 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5246 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5247 parameter.
5248
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005249 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5250 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5251 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5252 used on strings.
5253
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005254 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5255
5256 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5257 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5258 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5259 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5260 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5261 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5262 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5263 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5264 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5265 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5266 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5267 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005268
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005269 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5270 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5271 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005272
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005273 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005274
5275
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005276http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5277 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5278 ones).
5279
5280 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5281 no | yes | yes | yes
5282
5283 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5284 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5285 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5286 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5287 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5288 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5289
5290 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5291 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5292 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5293
5294 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5295 below.
5296
5297 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5298 instance.
5299
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005300 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5301 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5302 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5303
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005304 Example:
5305 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5306 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5307 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5308
5309http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5310
5311 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5312 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5313 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5314 example, or to pass some internal information.
5315 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5316 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5317 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5318
5319http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5320
5321 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5322 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5323
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005324http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005325
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005326 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5327 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5328 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5329 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5330 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005331
5332http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5333 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5334
5335 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5336
5337 Example:
5338 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5339
5340 # applied to:
5341 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5342
5343 # outputs:
5344 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5345
5346 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5347
5348http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5349 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5350
5351 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5352
5353 Example:
5354 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5355
5356 # applied to:
5357 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5358
5359 # outputs:
5360 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5361
5362http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5363
5364 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5365 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5366 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5367
5368http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5369 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5370
5371 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5372 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5373 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5374 fallback.
5375
5376 Example:
5377 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5378 http-response set-status 431
5379 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5380 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5381
5382http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5383
5384 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5385 inline.
5386
5387 Arguments:
5388 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5389 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5390 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5391 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5392 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5393 (request and response)
5394 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5395 processing
5396 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5397 processing
5398 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5399 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5400 and '_'.
5401
5402 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5403 followed by some converters.
5404
5405 Example:
5406 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5407
5408http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5409
5410 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5411 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5412 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5413 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5414 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005415 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005416 processing.
5417
5418 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5419 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005420 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005421 rules evaluation.
5422
5423http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5424
5425 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5426 details about <var-name>.
5427
5428 Example:
5429 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5430
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005431
5432http-check comment <string>
5433 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5434 it fails.
5435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5436 yes | no | yes | yes
5437
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005438 Arguments :
5439 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5440 rule fails.
5441
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005442 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5443 user-friendly error reporting.
5444
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005445 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005446 "http-check expect".
5447
5448
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005449http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5450 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005451 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005452 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5454 yes | no | yes | yes
5455
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005456 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005457 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5458
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005459 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005460 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005461
5462 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5463 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5464 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5465 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5466
5467 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5468
5469 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5470
5471 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5472
5473 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5474
5475 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5476
5477 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5478 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5479 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5480 is used.
5481
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005482 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5483 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5484 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5485 haproxy -vv.
5486
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005487 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5488
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005489 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5490 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5491 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5492 different ports or with different servers.
5493
5494 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5495 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5496 the port with a "http-check connect".
5497
5498 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5499 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5500 do.
5501
5502 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5503 unset-var or comment rules.
5504
5505 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005506 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5507 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5508 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5509 option httpchk
5510
5511 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005512 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005513 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005514 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005515 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005516 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005517
5518 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5519
5520 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005521
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005523http-check disable-on-404
5524 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005526 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005527 Arguments : none
5528
5529 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5530 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5531 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5532 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5533 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5534 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5535 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5536 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005537 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5538 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005539 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5540 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5541 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005542
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005543 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005544
5545
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005546http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005547 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5548 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5549 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005550 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005552 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005553
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005554 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005555 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5556
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005557 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5558 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5559 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5560 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5561 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5562 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5563 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5564 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5565 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5566 result is always conclusive.
5567
5568 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5569 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5570 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005571 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5572 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005573 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5574 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005575 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5576 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5577 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005578
5579 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5580 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005581 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5582 supported :
5583 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5584 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005585 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5586 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5587 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5588 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5589 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005590
5591 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5592 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005593 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5594 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5595 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5596 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005597 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5598
5599 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5600 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5601 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5602 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5603
5604 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5605 informational message reported in logs if an error
5606 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5607 log-format string.
5608
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005609 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005610 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5611 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005612 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5613 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5614 details on the supported keywords.
5615
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005616 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5617 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5618 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5619 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005620
5621 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5622 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5623 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5624 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5625 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5626
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005627 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5628 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5629 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5630 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5631 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5632 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5633 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005634
5635 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005636 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005637 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5638 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5639 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5640 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5641
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005642 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5643 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005644 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5645 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5646 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5647 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5648 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5649 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5650 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5651 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005652 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5653 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5654 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5655 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5656 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5657 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5658 insensitive on the header names.
5659
5660 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5661 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5662 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5663 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5664 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5665 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005666
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005667 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005668 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005669 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5670 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5671 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5672 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5673 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005674 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005675 trace).
5676
5677 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005678 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005679 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5680 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5681 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5682 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5683 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005684 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005686 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5687 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5688 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5689 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5690 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5691 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5692
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005693 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005694 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005695 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5696 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5697 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5698 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5699 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5700 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5701
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005702 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5703 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5704 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5705 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5706 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005707
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005708 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5709 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5710
5711 Examples :
5712 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005713 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005714
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005715 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5716 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5717
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005718 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005719 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005720
5721 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005722 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005723
5724 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005725 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005726
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005727 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005728 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005729
5730
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005731http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005732 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5733 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005734 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5735 health checks.
5736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5737 yes | no | yes | yes
5738 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005739 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5740
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005741 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5742 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5743 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5744 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5745 to invent non-standard ones.
5746
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005747 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5748 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5749 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5750 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5751
5752 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5753 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5754 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5755 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005756
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005757 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005758 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005759 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005760 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5761 to add it.
5762
5763 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5764 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5765 to the log-format rules.
5766
5767 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5768 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5769 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005770
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005771 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5772 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5773 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5774 request.
5775
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005776 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5777 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5778 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005779 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5780 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5781 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5782 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005783 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005784
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005785 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005786 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5787 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005788
5789 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5790 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5791 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5792 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5793 configured request authority.
5794
5795 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5796 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005797
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005798 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005799
5800
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005801http-check send-state
5802 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5804 yes | no | yes | yes
5805 Arguments : none
5806
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005807 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005808 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005809 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5810 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5811 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005812
5813 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5814 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5815 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5816 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5817 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005818 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5819 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5820 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5821
5822 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5823 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5824 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5825
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005826 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5827 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5828 checked in multiple backends.
5829
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005830 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005831 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5832
5833 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5834 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5835 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5836 one fails.
5837
5838 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5839 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5840 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5841
5842 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5843 server's queue.
5844
5845 Example of a header received by the application server :
5846 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5847 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5848
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005849 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5850 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005851
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005852
5853http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005854 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005855 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5856 yes | no | yes | yes
5857
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005858 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005859 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5860 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5861 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5862 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5863 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5864 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5865 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5866 and '-'.
5867
5868 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5869
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005870 Examples :
5871 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005872
5873
5874http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005875 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005876 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5877 yes | no | yes | yes
5878
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005879 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005880 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5881 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5882 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5883 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5884 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5885 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5886 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5887 and '-'.
5888
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005889 Examples :
5890 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005891
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005892
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005893http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5894 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5895 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5896 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5897 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 yes | yes | yes | yes
5900 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005901 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005902 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005903 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005904 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005905
5906 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5907 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5908 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5909 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5910
5911 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5912 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5913 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5914 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5915
5916 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5917 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5918 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5919 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5920 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5921 chroot is performed.
5922
5923 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5924 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5925 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5926 considered.
5927
5928 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5929 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5930 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5931 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5932 considered as a raw string.
5933
5934 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5935 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5936 "content-type".
5937
5938 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5939 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5940 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5941 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5942 evaluated as a log-format string.
5943
5944 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5945 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5946 argument to "content-type".
5947
5948 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5949 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5950 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5951 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5952
5953 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5954 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5955 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5956 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5957 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5958 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5959 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5960 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5961
5962 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5963 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5964 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5965
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005966 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5967 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5968 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5969 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5970 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5971
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005972 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5973 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5974
5975
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005976http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005977 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5978
5979 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5980 no | yes | yes | yes
5981
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005982 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5983 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5984 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5985 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5986 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005987
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005988 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5989 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005990
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005991 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005993 Example:
5994 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5995 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5996 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005998 http-request allow if nagios
5999 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6000 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6001 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003 Example:
6004 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6005 acl add path /addacl
6006 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006010 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6011 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006013 Example:
6014 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6015 acl setmap path /setmap
6016 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006018 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006020 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6021 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006023 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6024 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006027
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006028 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6029 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6030 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6031 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6032 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6033 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6034 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6035 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006036
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006037http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006039 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6040 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6041 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6042 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6043 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6044 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6045 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6046 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6051 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006052
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6057 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6058 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6059 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6060 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006061
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006062 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6063 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6064 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6065 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6066 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6067 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6068 instead.
6069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006070 Example:
6071 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6072 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006073
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006074http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006075
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006076 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006078http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6079 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006081 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6082 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6083 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6084 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6085 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6086 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6087 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6088 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6089 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006091 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6092 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6093 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006094 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6095
6096 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6097 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6098 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6099 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006101http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006103 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6104 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6105 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6106 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6107 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6108 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006109
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006110http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006111
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006112 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6113 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6114 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6115 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6116 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006118http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006120 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6121 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6122 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6123 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6124 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6125 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006126
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006127http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6128http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6129 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6130 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6131 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6132 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006133
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006134 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6135 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6136 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006137 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006138 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6139 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6140 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006141 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006142 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006143
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006144http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6145 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6146 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6147 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6148
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006149http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6150
6151 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6152 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6153 pointed by <resolvers>.
6154 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6155 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6156 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6157 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6158 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6159 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6160 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6161 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6162 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6163 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6164 to 0.0.0.0.
6165
6166 Example:
6167 resolvers mydns
6168 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6169 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6170 timeout retry 1s
6171 hold valid 10s
6172 hold nx 3s
6173 hold other 3s
6174 hold obsolete 0s
6175 accepted_payload_size 8192
6176
6177 frontend fe
6178 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6179 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6180 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6181
6182 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6183 # which mean DNS resolution error
6184 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6185
6186 default_backend be
6187
6188 backend b_503
6189 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6190 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6191 # 503 error page to end users
6192
6193 backend be
6194 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6195 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6196 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6197 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6198 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6199
6200 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6201 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6202
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006203http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6204
6205 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6206 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6207 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6208 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006209 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6210 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006211
6212 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6213
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006214http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006215http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006216http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006217http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006218http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006219http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006220http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006221http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6222http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006223
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006224 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6225
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006226 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006227 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6228 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6229 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6230 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006231
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006232 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6233 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6234 the supported backend.
6235
6236 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6237 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6238 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6239 number of segments in the path.
6240
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006241 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6242 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6243 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6244 when improperly combined.
6245
6246 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6247 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6248 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6249 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6250 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6251
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006252 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006253
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006254 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6255
6256 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6257 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6258
6259 Example:
6260 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6261
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006262 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6263
6264 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6265 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6266
6267 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6268 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6269
6270 Example:
6271 - /#foo -> /
6272
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006273 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6274 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006275
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006276 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6277 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6278
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006279 Example:
6280 - /. -> /
6281 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6282 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6283 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006284
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006285 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6286 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6287
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006288 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006289 their preceding segment.
6290
6291 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6292 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6293
6294 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6295 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006296
6297 Example:
6298 - /foo/../ -> /
6299 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6300 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6301 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006302 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006303 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006304 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006305
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006306 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6307 removed as well:
6308
6309 Example:
6310 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6311 - /bar/../../ -> /
6312
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006313 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6314 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006315
6316 Example:
6317 - // -> /
6318 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6319
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006320 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6321 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6322
6323 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6324 ".", "_", and "~".
6325
6326 Example:
6327 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6328 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6329 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6330 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6331
6332 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6333 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6334
6335 Example:
6336 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6337 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6338
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006339 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006340 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006341
6342 Example:
6343 - /%6f -> /%6F
6344 - /%zz -> /%zz
6345
6346 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6347 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6348
6349 Example:
6350 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6351
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006352 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006353 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6354 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6355
6356 Example:
6357 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6358 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6359 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006361http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006363 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6364 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6365 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6366 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6367 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006369http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006371 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6372 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6373 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6374 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006376http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6377 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006378
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006379 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006380 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6381 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6382 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6383 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6384 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006385
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006386 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6387 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6388 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6389 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6390 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006391
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006392 Example:
6393 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6394
6395 # applied to:
6396 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6397
6398 # outputs:
6399 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6400
6401 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006402
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006403 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6404
6405 # applied to:
6406 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006407
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006408 # outputs:
6409 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006410
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006411http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6412 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6413
6414 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6415 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006416 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6417 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6418 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006419
6420 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6421 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6422 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6423
6424 Example:
6425 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6426 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6427
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006428 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6429 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6430 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6431 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6432
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006433http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6434 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6435
6436 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6437 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6438 query-string are replaced.
6439
6440 Example:
6441 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6442 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6443
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006444http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6446
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006447 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6448 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6449 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6450 against.
6451
6452 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6453 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6454 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006455
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006456 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6457 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6458 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6459 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6460 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6461 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6462 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6463 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6464 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006465 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6466 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006467
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006468 Example:
6469 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6470 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006471
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006472 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6473 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006474
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006475http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6476 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006477
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006478 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6479 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6480 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6481 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006482
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006483 Example:
6484 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006485
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006486 # applied to:
6487 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006488
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006489 # outputs:
6490 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006491
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006492http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6493 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6494 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006495 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006496 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6497
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006498 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006499 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6500 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006501 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006502 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006503 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006504 are followed to create the response :
6505
6506 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6507 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6508 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6509 ignored.
6510
6511 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6512 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006513 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006514 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6515 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006516
6517 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6518 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6519 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006520 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006521 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006522
6523 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6524 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6525 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006526 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006527 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006528 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006529
6530 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6531 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6532 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6533 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6534 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6535 as a raw content.
6536
6537 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6538 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6539 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6540 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6541 considered as a raw string.
6542
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006543 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006544 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6545 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6546 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6547
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006548 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6549 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006550 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006551
6552 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6553
6554 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006555 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006556 if { path /ping }
6557
6558 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6559 if { path /favicon.ico }
6560
6561 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6562 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6563 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6564
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006565http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6566http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006568 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6569 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6570 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006571
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006572http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6573 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006575 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6576 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6577 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6578 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006580http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006582 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6583 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6584 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6585 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6586 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006588 Arguments:
6589 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6590 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006591
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006592 Example:
6593 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6594 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6597 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006601 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6602 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6603 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006605 Arguments:
6606 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6607 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006608
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006609 Example:
6610 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6611 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006613 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6614 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6615 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006616
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006617http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006619 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6620 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6621 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6622 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6623 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006625 Example:
6626 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6627 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6628 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6629 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6630 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6631 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6632 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6633 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6634 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006636http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6639 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6640 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6641 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6642 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006644http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6645 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006646
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006647 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6648 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6649 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6650 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6651 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6652 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6653 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6654 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6655 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006657http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006659 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6660 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6661 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6662 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6663 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6664 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6665 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006666
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006667http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006669 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6670 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6671 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006673http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006675 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6676 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6677 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6678 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6679 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6680 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6681 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6682 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006684http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006686 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6687 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6688 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6689 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6690 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6691 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006693 Example :
6694 # prepend the host name before the path
6695 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006696
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006697http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6698
6699 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6700 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6701 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6702
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006703http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006705 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6706 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6707 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6708 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6709 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006710
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006711http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006713 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6714 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6715 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6716 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6717 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6718 values have higher priority.
6719 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6720 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6721 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6722 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6723 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006724
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006725http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006727 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6728 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6729 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6730 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6731 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6732 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6733 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006735 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006736
6737 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006738 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6739 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006741http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6742 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6743 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6744 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006745 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6746 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006747
6748 Arguments :
6749 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6750 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006751
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006752 See also "option forwardfor".
6753
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006754 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006755 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6756 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6757
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006758 # After the masking this will track connections
6759 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6760 http-request track-sc0 src
6761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006762 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6763 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6764
6765http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6766
6767 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6768 expression.
6769
6770 Arguments:
6771 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6772 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006773
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006774 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006775 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6776 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6777
6778 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6779 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6780 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6781
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006782http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006783 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6784
6785 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6786 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6787 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6788 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6789 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6790
6791 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6792 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6793 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6794 results.
6795
6796 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006797 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6798 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006799
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006800http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6801
6802 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6803 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6804 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6805 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6806 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6807 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6808 information from the request.
6809
6810 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6811
6812http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6813
6814 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6815 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6816 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6817 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6818 path and the query string.
6819 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6820
6821http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6822
6823 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6824 inline.
6825
6826 Arguments:
6827 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6828 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6829 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6830 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6831 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6832 (request and response)
6833 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6834 processing
6835 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6836 processing
6837 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6838 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6839 and '_'.
6840
6841 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6842 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006843
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006844 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006845 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006846
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006847http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6848 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006850 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6851 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6852 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6853 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6854 agent name must be used.
6855
6856 Arguments:
6857 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6858
6859 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6860 configuration.
6861
6862http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6863
6864 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6865 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6866 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6867 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6868 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6869 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6870 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6871 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6872 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6873 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6874 action.
6875 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6876 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6877 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6878 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6879 you fully understand how it works.
6880
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006881http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6882
6883 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6884 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6885 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6886 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6887 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006888 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006889 processing.
6890
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006891 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006892 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6893 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6894 rules evaluation.
6895
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006896http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6897http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6898 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6899 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6900 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6901 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006902
6903 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6904 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6905 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006906 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6907 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6908 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6909 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6910 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6911 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006912 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006913 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6914 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6915 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006916 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006917 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6918 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6919 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6920 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6921 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006922
6923http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6924http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6925http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6926
6927 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6928 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6929 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6930 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006931 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006932 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6933 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6934 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6935 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6936 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6937 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6938 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6939
6940 Arguments :
6941 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6942 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6943 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6944 select which table entry to update the counters.
6945
6946 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6947 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6948 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6949 that table until the session ends.
6950
6951 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6952 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6953 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6954 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6955 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6956 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6957 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6958 useful information.
6959
6960 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6961 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6962 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6963 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6964 checks that make use of it.
6965
6966http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6967
6968 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006969
6970 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006971 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006972
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006973http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6974
6975 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6976 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6977 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6978 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6979 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6980 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6981
6982 Arguments :
6983 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6984
6985 Example:
6986 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6987
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006988http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6989 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6990
6991 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6992 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6993 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6994 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6995 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6996 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6997 http-buffer-request".
6998
6999 Arguments :
7000
7001 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7002 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7003
7004 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007005 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007006 bytes.
7007
7008 Example:
7009 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7010
7011 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007013http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007014
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007015 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7016 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7017 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007018
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007019
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007020http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007021 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7022
7023 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7024 no | yes | yes | yes
7025
7026 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7027 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7028 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7029 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7030 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7031 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007033 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7034 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007036 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007038 Example:
7039 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007041 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007043 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7044 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007046 Example:
7047 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007049 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007051 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7052 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7055 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007057http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007059 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7060 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7061 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7062 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7063 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7064 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7065 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7066 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007070 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7071 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7072 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7073 example, or to pass some internal information.
7074 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7075 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7076 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007080 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7081 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007082
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007083http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007084
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007085 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007089 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7090 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7091 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7092 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7093 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7094 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7095 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007096
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007097 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7098 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7099 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7100 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7101 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007102
7103 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7104 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7105 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7106 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007107
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007108http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007110 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7111 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7112 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7113 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7114 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7115 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007116
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007117http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007118
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007119 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7120 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7121 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7122 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7123 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007125http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007127 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7128 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7129 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7130 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7131 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7132 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007133
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007134http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7135http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7136 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7137 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7138 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7139 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007140
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007141 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7142 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7143 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007144 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007145 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7146 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7147 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007148 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007149 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007150
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007151http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007153 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7154 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7155 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7156 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7157 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7158 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007160http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7161 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007162
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007163 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7164 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007165
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007166 Example:
7167 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007169 # applied to:
7170 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007172 # outputs:
7173 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007175 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007177http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7178 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007179
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007180 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007181 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007183 Example:
7184 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007186 # applied to:
7187 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007189 # outputs:
7190 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007191
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007192http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7193 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7194 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007195 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007196 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7197
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007198 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007199 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7200 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007201 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007202 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007203 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007204 are followed to create the response :
7205
7206 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7207 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7208 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7209 ignored.
7210
7211 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7212 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007213 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007214 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7215 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007216
7217 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7218 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7219 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007220 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007221 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007222
7223 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7224 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7225 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007226 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007227 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007228 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007229
7230 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7231 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7232 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7233 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7234 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7235 as a raw content.
7236
7237 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7238 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7239 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7240 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7241 considered as a raw string.
7242
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007243 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7244 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7245 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7246 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7247
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007248 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7249 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007250 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007251
7252 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7253
7254 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007255 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007256 if { status eq 404 }
7257
7258 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7259 string "This is the end !" \
7260 if { status eq 500 }
7261
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007262http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7263http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007265 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7266 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7267 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007268
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007269http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7270 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007271
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007272 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7273 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7274 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7275 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007276
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007277http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7278 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007279
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007280 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7281 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7282 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7283 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7284 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007285
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007286 Arguments:
7287 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007288
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007289 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7290 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007291
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007292http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007293
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007294 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7295 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7296 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007297
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007298http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7299
7300 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7301 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7302 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7303 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7304 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7305
7306http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7307
7308 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7309 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7310 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7311 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7312 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7313 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7314 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7315 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7316 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7317
7318http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7319
7320 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7321 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7322 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7323 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7324 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7325 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7326 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7327
7328http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7329
7330 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7331 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7332 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7333 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7334 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7335 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7336 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7337 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7338
7339http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7340 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7341
7342 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7343 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7344 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7345 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007346
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007347 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007348 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7349 http-response set-status 431
7350 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7351 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007352
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007353http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007354
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007355 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7356 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7357 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7358 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7359 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7360 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7361 based on some information from the request.
7362
7363 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7364
7365http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7366
7367 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7368 inline.
7369
7370 Arguments:
7371 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7372 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7373 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7374 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7375 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7376 (request and response)
7377 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7378 processing
7379 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7380 processing
7381 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7382 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7383 and '_'.
7384
7385 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7386 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007387
7388 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007389 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007390
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007391http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007392
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007393 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7394 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7395 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7396 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7397 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7398 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7399 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7400 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7401 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7402 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7403 action.
7404 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7405 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7406 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7407 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7408 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007409
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007410http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7411
7412 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7413 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7414 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7415 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7416 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007417 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007418 processing.
7419
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007420 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007421 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007422 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007423 rules evaluation.
7424
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007425http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7426http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7427http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007428
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007429 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7430 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7431 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7432 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7433 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007434 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007435
7436http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7437
7438 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7439 about <var-name>.
7440
7441 Example:
7442 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7443
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007444http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7445 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7446
7447 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7448 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7449 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7450 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7451 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7452 buffer is full.
7453
7454 Arguments :
7455
7456 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7457 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7458
7459 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007460 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007461 bytes.
7462
7463 Example:
7464 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007465
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007466http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7467 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7468
7469 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7470 yes | no | yes | yes
7471
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007472 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007473 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7474 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7475 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007476
7477 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7478
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007479 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7480 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7481 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7482 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7483 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7484 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7485 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007486 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007487 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7488 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007489
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007490 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7491 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7492 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7493 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7494 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7495 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7496 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007497 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7498 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7499 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7500 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7501 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7502 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007503
7504 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7505 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7506 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7507 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7508 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7509 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7510 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7511 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007512 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007513 downsides of rare connection failures.
7514
7515 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7516 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7517 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7518 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7519 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7520 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007521 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007522 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7523 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7524 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7525 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7526 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7527
7528 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007529 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7530 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7531 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7532 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007533
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007534 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7535 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007536
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007537 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007538
7539 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7540 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7541 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7542
7543 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7544
7545
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007546http-send-name-header [<header>]
7547 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007548 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7549 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007550 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007551 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7552
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007553 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7554 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7555 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7556 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7557 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7558 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7559 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7560 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7561 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7562 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7563 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7564 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7565 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7566 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7567 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7568 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007569
7570 See also : "server"
7571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007572id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007573 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7575 no | yes | yes | yes
7576 Arguments : none
7577
7578 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7579 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7580 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007581
7582
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007583ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7584 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7585 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007586 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007587
7588 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7589 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7590 and running).
7591
7592 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7593 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7594 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007595 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007596 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7597
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007598 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7599 "unless" condition is met.
7600
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007601 Example:
7602 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7603 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7604 ignore-persist if url_static
7605
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007606 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7607
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007608load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7609 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7611 yes | no | yes | yes
7612
7613 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7614 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7615 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007616 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007617 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007618 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7619 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7620 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7621
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007622 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007623 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007624 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007625
7626 Arguments:
7627 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7628 named "server-state-file".
7629
7630 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7631 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7632 name is used as a file name.
7633
7634 none don't load any stat for this backend
7635
7636 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007637 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7638 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7639 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007640 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007641 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007642
7643 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7644 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7645
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007646 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007647
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007648 global
7649 stats socket /tmp/socket
7650 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007651
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007652 defaults
7653 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007654
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007655 backend bk
7656 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7657 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007658
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007659
7660 Then one can run :
7661
7662 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7663
7664 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7665
7666 1
7667 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7668 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7669 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7670
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007671 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007672
7673 global
7674 stats socket /tmp/socket
7675 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7676
7677 defaults
7678 load-server-state-from-file local
7679
7680 backend bk
7681 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7682 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7683
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007684
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007685 Then one can run :
7686
7687 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7688
7689 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7690
7691 1
7692 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7693 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7694 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7695
7696 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7697 "show servers state"
7698
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007700log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007701log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007702 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007703no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007704 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7706 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007707
7708 Prefix :
7709 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7710 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7711 prefix does not allow arguments.
7712
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007713 Arguments :
7714 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7715 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7716 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7717 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7718 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7719 parameter.
7720
7721 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7722 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7723
7724 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7725 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7726 standard syslog port).
7727
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007728 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7729 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7730 standard syslog port).
7731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007732 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7733 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7734 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007735 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007736
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007737 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7738 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7739 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7740 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7741 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7742 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7743 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7744 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7745 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7746 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7747 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7748 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007749 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007750 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7751 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7752 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007753 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7754 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007755
7756 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7757 and "fd@2", see above.
7758
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007759 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7760 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7761 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7762 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7763 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7764 having the logs instantly available.
7765
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007766 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7767 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7768 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7769
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007770 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7771 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007772
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007773 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7774 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7775 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7776 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7777 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7778 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7779 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7780 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7781 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7782 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007783 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007784
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007785 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7786 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7787 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7788 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7789 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7790
7791 <sample_size>
7792 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7793 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7794 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7795 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7796 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7797
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007798 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7799 one of the following :
7800
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007801 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7802 field is stripped. This is the default.
7803 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7804 rfc3164.
7805
7806 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007807 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7808
7809 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7810 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7811
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007812 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7813 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7814 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7815 designed to be used with a local log server.
7816
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007817 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7818 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7819 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7820 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7821 systemd logger consumes.
7822
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007823 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7824 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7825 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7826 used with a local log server.
7827
7828 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7829 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7830 designed to be used with a local log server.
7831
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007832 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7833 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7834 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7835 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7836
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007837 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7838
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007839 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7840 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7841 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7842
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007843 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7844 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7845 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7846 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007847
7848 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7849 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7850 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007851 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7852 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7853 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7854 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7855 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007856
7857 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7858
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007859 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7860 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7861 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007862
7863 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7864 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7865 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7866 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7867
7868 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7869 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007870
7871 Example :
7872 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007873 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7874 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7875 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007876 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007877 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7878 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007879 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007880
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007881
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007882log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007883 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7884 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7885 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007886
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007887 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7888 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7889 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7890 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7891 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007892
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007893 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7894 "option httplog" directives.
7895
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007896log-format-sd <string>
7897 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7898 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7899 yes | yes | yes | no
7900
7901 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7902 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7903 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7904 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7905 which covers the log format string in depth.
7906
7907 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7908 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7909
7910 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7911 log format to "rfc5424".
7912
7913 Example :
7914 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7915
7916
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007917log-tag <string>
7918 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7920 yes | yes | yes | yes
7921
7922 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7923 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007924 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007925 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7926 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7927 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7928 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7929 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7930 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007931
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007932max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7933 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7934 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 yes | no | yes | yes
7936
7937 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7938 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7939 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7940 servers.
7941
7942 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007943 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007944 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7945 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7946 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007947 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007948 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7949 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7950 picking a different server.
7951
7952 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7953 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7954 even if they have to be queued.
7955
7956 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7957 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7958
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007959max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7960 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7961 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7962 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007963
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007964maxconn <conns>
7965 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7967 yes | yes | yes | no
7968 Arguments :
7969 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7970 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7971 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7972 closes.
7973
7974 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007975 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007976 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7977 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007978 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7979 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7980 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7981 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007982
7983 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7984 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7985 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7986
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007987 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7988 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007990 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7991
7992
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007993mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007994 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7996 yes | yes | yes | yes
7997 Arguments :
7998 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7999 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8000 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8001 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8002
8003 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8004 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8005 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8006 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8007 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8008
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008009 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8010 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8011 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008012
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008013 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008014 defaults http_instances
8015 mode http
8016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008017
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008018monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008019 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008022 Arguments :
8023 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8024 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008025 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008026 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8027 backend and its backup.
8028
8029 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8030 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8031 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8032 servers in a list of backends.
8033
8034 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8035 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8036 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008037 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008038 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8039 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008040 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008041 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8042 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008043
8044 Example:
8045 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008046 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008047 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8048 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8049 monitor-uri /site_alive
8050 monitor fail if site_dead
8051
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008052 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008053
8054
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008055monitor-uri <uri>
8056 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8058 yes | yes | yes | no
8059 Arguments :
8060 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8061 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8062
8063 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8064 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8065 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8066 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8067 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8068 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8069 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8070 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8071
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008072 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008073 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8074 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8075 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8076 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8077 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8078 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008079
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008080 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8081 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8082 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8083 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8084
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008085 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008086 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008087 frontend www
8088 mode http
8089 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8090
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008091 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008092
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008093
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008094option abortonclose
8095no option abortonclose
8096 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8098 yes | no | yes | yes
8099 Arguments : none
8100
8101 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8102 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8103 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8104 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008105 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008106 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8107 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8108 encountered while delivering the response.
8109
8110 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8111 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8112 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8113 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8114 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8115 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008116 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008117 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008118 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008119 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8120 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8121 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8122
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008123 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8124 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008125 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8126 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8127 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8128 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8129 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8130 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008131 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008132
8133 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8134 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8135
8136 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8137
8138
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008139option accept-invalid-http-request
8140no option accept-invalid-http-request
8141 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8143 yes | yes | yes | no
8144 Arguments : none
8145
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008146 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008147 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008148 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008149 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8150 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8151 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8152 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8153 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008154 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8155 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8156 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8157 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008158 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008159 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008160 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8161 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8162 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008163
8164 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8165 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8166 been confirmed.
8167
8168 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8169 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008170 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8171 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008172 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8173
8174 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8175 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8176
8177 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8178 stats socket.
8179
8180
8181option accept-invalid-http-response
8182no option accept-invalid-http-response
8183 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8185 yes | no | yes | yes
8186 Arguments : none
8187
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008188 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008189 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008190 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008191 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8192 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8193 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8194 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8195 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008196 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8197 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8198 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008199
8200 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8201 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8202 been confirmed.
8203
8204 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8205 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8206 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8207 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8208
8209 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8210 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8211
8212 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8213 stats socket.
8214
8215
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008216option allbackups
8217no option allbackups
8218 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8220 yes | no | yes | yes
8221 Arguments : none
8222
8223 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8224 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8225 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8226 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8227 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8228 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8229 order between the backup servers anymore.
8230
8231 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8232 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8233
8234 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8235 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8236
8237
8238option checkcache
8239no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008240 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8242 yes | no | yes | yes
8243 Arguments : none
8244
8245 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8246 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008247 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008248 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8249 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008250 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008251
8252 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008253 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008254 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008255 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8256 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008257 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008258 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008259 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8260 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008261 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008262 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8263 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008264 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008265 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8266 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8267 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8268 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8269 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8270 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8271 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8272 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8273 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8274
8275 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008276 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8277 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8278 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8279 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008280
8281 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8282 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008283 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008284 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008285
8286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8288
8289
8290option clitcpka
8291no option clitcpka
8292 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8294 yes | yes | yes | no
8295 Arguments : none
8296
8297 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8298 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008299 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008300 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8301
8302 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8303 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8304 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8305 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8306
8307 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8308 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8309 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8310 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8311 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8312
8313 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8314
8315 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8316 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8317 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8318
8319 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8320 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8321
8322 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8323
8324
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008325option contstats
8326 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8328 yes | yes | yes | no
8329 Arguments : none
8330
8331 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8332 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8333 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008334 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008335 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8336 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8337 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8338 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8339 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008340
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008341option disable-h2-upgrade
8342no option disable-h2-upgrade
8343 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8344 connection.
8345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8346 yes | yes | yes | no
8347 Arguments : none
8348
8349 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8350 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8351 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8352 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008353 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8354 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8355 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8356 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8357 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8358 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008359
8360 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8361 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008362
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008363option dontlog-normal
8364no option dontlog-normal
8365 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8367 yes | yes | yes | no
8368 Arguments : none
8369
8370 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8371 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8372 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8373 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8374 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8375 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8376 logged.
8377
8378 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8379 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8380 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008382 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008383 logging.
8384
8385
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008386option dontlognull
8387no option dontlognull
8388 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8390 yes | yes | yes | no
8391 Arguments : none
8392
8393 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8394 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8395 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8396 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8397 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8398 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008399 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8400 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8401 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008402
8403 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008404 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008405 would not be logged.
8406
8407 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8408 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8409
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008410 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008411 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008412
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008413
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008414option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008415 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8417 yes | yes | yes | yes
8418 Arguments :
8419 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8420 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008421 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008422 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008423
8424 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8425 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8426 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8427 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8428 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8429 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8430 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008431 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8432 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8433 possible that the client has already brought one.
8434
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008435 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008436 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008437 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008438 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008439 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008440 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008441
8442 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8443 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8444 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8445 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8446 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8447 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008448 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008449
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008450 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8451 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008452 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008453 are under the control of the end-user.
8454
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008455 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008456 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8457 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008458 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8459 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8460 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008461
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008462 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008463 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8464 frontend www
8465 mode http
8466 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8467
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008468 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8469 backend www
8470 mode http
8471 option forwardfor header X-Client
8472
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008473 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008474 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008475
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008476
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008477option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8478no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8479 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8481 yes | yes | yes | no
8482 Arguments : none
8483
8484 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8485 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8486 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8487 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8488 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8489 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8490 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8491
8492 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8493 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8494 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8495 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8496 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8497 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8498 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8499 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8500 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8501 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8502
8503 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8504
8505 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8506 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8507
8508 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8509 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8510
8511
8512option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8513no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8514 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8516 yes | no | yes | yes
8517 Arguments : none
8518
8519 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8520 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8521 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8522 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8523 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8524 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8525 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8526
8527 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8528 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8529 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8530 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8531 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8532 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8533 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8534 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8535 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8536 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8537
8538 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8539
8540 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8541 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8542
8543 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8544 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8545
8546
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008547option http-buffer-request
8548no option http-buffer-request
8549 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8551 yes | yes | yes | yes
8552 Arguments : none
8553
8554 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8555 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8556 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8557 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8558 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8559 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008560 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8561 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8562 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8563 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008564
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008565 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8566 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008567
8568
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008569option http-ignore-probes
8570no option http-ignore-probes
8571 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8573 yes | yes | yes | no
8574 Arguments : none
8575
8576 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8577 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8578 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8579 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8580 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8581 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8582 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8583 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8584 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008585 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8586 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008587 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8588
8589 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8590 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8591 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8592 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8593 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8594 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8595 are often the only way to detect them.
8596
8597 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8598 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8599
8600 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8601
8602
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008603option http-keep-alive
8604no option http-keep-alive
8605 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8607 yes | yes | yes | yes
8608 Arguments : none
8609
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008610 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8611 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008612 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8613 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008614 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8615 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8616 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008617
8618 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8619 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008620 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8621 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8622 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8623 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8624 situations where this option may be useful :
8625
8626 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008627 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008628
8629 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8630 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8631
8632 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8633 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8634 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8635 request.
8636
8637 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8638 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008639 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8640 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8641 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008642
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008643 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8644 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8645 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8646 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8647 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8648 not set.
8649
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008650 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8651 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8652 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008653
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008654 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008655 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008656 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008657
8658
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008659option http-no-delay
8660no option http-no-delay
8661 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8663 yes | yes | yes | yes
8664 Arguments : none
8665
8666 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8667 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8668 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8669 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8670 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8671 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8672 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008673 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008674 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8675 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8676 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8677 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8678 affected.
8679
8680 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8681 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8682 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8683 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8684 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8685 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8686 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8687 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8688 latency environments.
8689
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008690 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8691
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008692
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008693option http-pretend-keepalive
8694no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008695 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008697 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008698 Arguments : none
8699
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008700 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008701 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8702 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8703 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008704 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008705 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8706 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8707 consider the response complete.
8708
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008709 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008710 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008711 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008712 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008713 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008714 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8715
8716 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8717 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8718 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8719 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008720 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8721 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008722 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8723
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008724 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8725 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8726 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8727 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8728 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8729 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008730
8731 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8732 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8733
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008734 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008735 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008736
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008737option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8738 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8739 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8741 yes | yes | yes | yes
8742 Arguments :
8743 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8744 with no FastCGI application configured.
8745
8746 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8747 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8748 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8749
8750 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8751 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8752
8753 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8754 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8755 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8756 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8757 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8758 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8759 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8760 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8761
8762 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8763 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008764
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008765option http-server-close
8766no option http-server-close
8767 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8769 yes | yes | yes | yes
8770 Arguments : none
8771
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008772 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8773 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8774 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8775 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008776 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8777 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8778 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8779 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8780 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8781 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8782 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8783 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8784 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8785 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8786 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008787
8788 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8789 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8790 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8791 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008792 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8793 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008794
8795 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8796 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008797 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8798 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8799 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008800
8801 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8802 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8803
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008804 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8805 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008806
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008807option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008808no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008809 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8811 yes | yes | yes | no
8812 Arguments : none
8813
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008814 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008815 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8816 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8817 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8818 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8819 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008820 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008821
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008822 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008823 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008824 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8825 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8826 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008827
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008828 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8829 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8830 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8831 front of an existing proxy.
8832
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008833 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8834
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008835 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008836
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008837option httpchk
8838option httpchk <uri>
8839option httpchk <method> <uri>
8840option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008841 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8843 yes | no | yes | yes
8844 Arguments :
8845 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8846 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8847 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8848 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8849 ones.
8850
8851 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8852 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8853 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8854
8855 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8856 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8857 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008858 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008859
8860 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8861 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8862 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8863 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8864 the lack of any response.
8865
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008866 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8867 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8868 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8869 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8870
8871 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8872 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8873 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008874
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008875 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8876 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008877 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008878 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008879 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008880
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008881 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8882 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8883 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8884 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8885
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008886 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008887 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8888 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8889 backend https_relay
8890 mode tcp
8891 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8892 http-check send hdr Host www
8893 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008894
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008895 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8896 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8897 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008898
8899
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008900option httpclose
8901no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008902 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8904 yes | yes | yes | yes
8905 Arguments : none
8906
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008907 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8908 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8909 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8910 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008911 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008912
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008913 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8914 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008915 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008916 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8917 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008918
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008919 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8920 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8921 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008922
8923 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8924 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008925 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8926 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8927 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008928
8929 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8930 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8931
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008932 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008933
8934
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008935option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008936 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008938 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008939 Arguments :
8940 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8941 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8942 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008943 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008944 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008945
8946 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8947 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8948 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8949 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8950 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8951 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8952 ports.
8953
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008954 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8955 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008956
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008957 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008959 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008960
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008961
8962option http_proxy
8963no option http_proxy
8964 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8966 yes | yes | yes | yes
8967 Arguments : none
8968
8969 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8970 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8971 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8972 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8973 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8974
8975 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8976 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008977 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8978 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008979
8980 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8981 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8982
8983 Example :
8984 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8985 backend direct_forward
8986 option httpclose
8987 option http_proxy
8988
8989 See also : "option httpclose"
8990
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008991
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008992option independent-streams
8993no option independent-streams
8994 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8996 yes | yes | yes | yes
8997 Arguments : none
8998
8999 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9000 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9001 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9002 receive data or not.
9003
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009004 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009005 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9006 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9007 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9008 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9009 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9010 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9011 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9012 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9013 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9014 socket buffers.
9015
9016 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9017 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9018 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9019 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9020 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9021
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009022 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009023
9024
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009025option ldap-check
9026 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9028 yes | no | yes | yes
9029 Arguments : none
9030
9031 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9032 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9033 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9034 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9035
9036 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9037 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9038
9039 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9040 configure it.
9041
9042 Example :
9043 option ldap-check
9044
9045 See also : "option httpchk"
9046
9047
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009048option external-check
9049 Use external processes for server health checks
9050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9051 yes | no | yes | yes
9052
9053 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9054 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9055 command".
9056
9057 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9058
9059 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9060
9061
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009062option idle-close-on-response
9063no option idle-close-on-response
9064 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9066 yes | yes | yes | no
9067 Arguments : none
9068
9069 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9070 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9071 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9072 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9073 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9074 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9075 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9076 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9077 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9078
9079 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9080 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9081
9082 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9083 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9084 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9085 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9086
9087 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9088 "hard-stop-after"
9089
9090
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009091option log-health-checks
9092no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009093 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9095 yes | no | yes | yes
9096 Arguments : none
9097
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009098 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9099 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9100 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009101
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009102 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9103 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9104 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9105 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9106 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9107
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009108 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009109 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009110
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009111 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9112 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9113 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009114
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009115
9116option log-separate-errors
9117no option log-separate-errors
9118 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9120 yes | yes | yes | no
9121 Arguments : none
9122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009123 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009124 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9125 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9126 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9127 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9128 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9129 provides very important information.
9130
9131 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9132 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9133 error logs.
9134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009135 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009136 logging.
9137
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009138
9139option logasap
9140no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009141 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9143 yes | yes | yes | no
9144 Arguments : none
9145
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009146 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9147 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9148 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9149 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9150
9151 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9152 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9153 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9154 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9155 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009156 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009157 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9158 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9159 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9160 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009161 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009162
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009163 Examples :
9164 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9165 mode http
9166 option httplog
9167 option logasap
9168 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9169
9170 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9171 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9172 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9173 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009175 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009176 logging.
9177
9178
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009179option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009180 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9182 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009183 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009184 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9185 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009186 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9187 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009188
9189 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9190 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009191 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009192 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009193 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9194 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9195 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009196
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009197 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9198 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9199 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009200
9201 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009202 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009203 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9204 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9205 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9206 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9207 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9208 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9209 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9210
9211 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9212 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009213
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009214 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009215
9216 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9217 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9218 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9219 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009220 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009221 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009222
9223 See also: "option httpchk"
9224
9225
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009226option nolinger
9227no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009228 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009229 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9230 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009231 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009232
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009233 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009234 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9235 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9236 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9237 connections.
9238
9239 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9240 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009241 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9242 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9243 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9244 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9245 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9246 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9247 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9248 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9249 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9250 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9251 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9252 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9253 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009254
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009255 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9256 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9257 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9258 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9259 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009260
9261 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9262 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009263 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009264 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009265 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009266
9267 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9268 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9269
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009270 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9271 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009272
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009273option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9274 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9276 yes | yes | yes | yes
9277 Arguments :
9278 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9279 matching <network>
9280 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9281 header name.
9282
9283 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9284 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9285 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9286 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9287 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9288 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9289 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9290 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9291 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9292 possible that the client has already brought one.
9293
9294 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9295 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9296 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9297 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9298 header and requires different one.
9299
9300 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9301 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9302 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009303 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9304 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9305 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9306 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9307 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009308
9309 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9310 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9311 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9312 both are defined.
9313
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009314 Examples :
9315 # Original Destination address
9316 frontend www
9317 mode http
9318 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9319
9320 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9321 backend www
9322 mode http
9323 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9324
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009325 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009326
9327
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009328option persist
9329no option persist
9330 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9331 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9332 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009333 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009334
9335 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9336 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9337 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9338 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9339 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9340 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9341 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9342 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9343 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9344 redirected to another valid server.
9345
9346 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9347 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9348
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009349 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009350
9351
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009352option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9353 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9355 yes | no | yes | yes
9356 Arguments :
9357 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9358 PostgreSQL server.
9359
9360 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9361 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9362 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9363 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9364
9365 See also: "option httpchk"
9366
9367
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009368option prefer-last-server
9369no option prefer-last-server
9370 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9371 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9372 yes | no | yes | yes
9373 Arguments : none
9374
9375 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009376 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009377 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9378 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009379 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009380 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009381 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009382 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9383 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009384 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009385 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009386 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9387 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9388 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009389 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9390 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9391 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009392
9393 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9394 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9395
9396 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9397
9398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009399option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009400option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009401no option redispatch
9402 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9403 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9404 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009405 Arguments :
9406 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9407 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9408 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009409 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009410 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009411 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009412 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9413 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9414 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009416
9417 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9418 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9419 be able to access the service anymore.
9420
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009421 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9422 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009423
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009424 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9425 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9426 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9427 following order:
9428
9429 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9430
9431 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9432 list, or
9433
9434 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9435
9436 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9437 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9438
9439 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9440 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9441 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9442 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9443
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009444 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009445 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9446 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9450
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009451 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009452
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009453
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009454option redis-check
9455 Use redis health checks for server testing
9456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9457 yes | no | yes | yes
9458 Arguments : none
9459
9460 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9461 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9462 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9463 find the "+PONG" response message.
9464
9465 Example :
9466 option redis-check
9467
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009468 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009469
9470
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009471option smtpchk
9472option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9473 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9475 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009476 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009477 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009478 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009479 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9480
9481 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9482 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9483 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9484
9485 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9486 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9487 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9488 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9489 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9490 dead server.
9491
9492 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9493 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009494 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009495 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9496
9497 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9498 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9499 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9500 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009501 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009502
9503 Example :
9504 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9505
9506 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9507
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009509option socket-stats
9510no option socket-stats
9511
9512 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9514 yes | yes | yes | no
9515
9516 Arguments : none
9517
9518
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009519option splice-auto
9520no option splice-auto
9521 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9523 yes | yes | yes | yes
9524 Arguments : none
9525
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009526 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009527 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009528 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009529 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009530 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009531 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9532 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9533 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9534 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9535
9536 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9537 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9538 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9539 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9540 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9541 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9542 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9543 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9544 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9545 keyword.
9546
9547 Example :
9548 option splice-auto
9549
9550 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9551 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9552
9553 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9554 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9555
9556
9557option splice-request
9558no option splice-request
9559 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9561 yes | yes | yes | yes
9562 Arguments : none
9563
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009564 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009565 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009566 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9567 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9568 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9569 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9570
9571 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9572
9573 Example :
9574 option splice-request
9575
9576 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9577 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9578
9579 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9580 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9581
9582
9583option splice-response
9584no option splice-response
9585 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9587 yes | yes | yes | yes
9588 Arguments : none
9589
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009590 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009591 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009592 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9593 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9594 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9595 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9596
9597 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9598
9599 Example :
9600 option splice-response
9601
9602 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9603 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9604
9605 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9606 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9607
9608
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009609option spop-check
9610 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9612 no | no | no | yes
9613 Arguments : none
9614
9615 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9616 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9617 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9618 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9619
9620 Example :
9621 option spop-check
9622
9623 See also : "option httpchk"
9624
9625
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009626option srvtcpka
9627no option srvtcpka
9628 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9630 yes | no | yes | yes
9631 Arguments : none
9632
9633 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9634 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009635 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009636 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9637
9638 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9639 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9640 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9641 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9642
9643 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9644 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9645 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9646 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9647 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9648
9649 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9650
9651 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9652 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9653 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9654
9655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9657
9658 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9659
9660
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009661option ssl-hello-chk
9662 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9664 yes | no | yes | yes
9665 Arguments : none
9666
9667 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9668 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9669 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9670 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9671 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9672 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9673 hello message.
9674
9675 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9676 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9677 messages, which is appreciable.
9678
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009679 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009680 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9681 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009682
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009683 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9684
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009685
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009686option tcp-check
9687 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9688 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9689 yes | no | yes | yes
9690
9691 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9692 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9693
9694 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9695 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9696 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9697
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009698 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009699 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9700 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9701 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9702 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9703 only.
9704
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009705 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009706 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009707 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9708 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9709 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9710
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009711 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009712 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9713 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009714 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009715 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9716 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9717 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9718 the respective protocols.
9719 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009720 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009721
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009722 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009723
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009724 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9725 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9726 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9727 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009728
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009729 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9730 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9731 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009732
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009733
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009734 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009735 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009736 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009737 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009738
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009739 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009740 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009741 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009742
9743 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9744 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009745 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009746 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009747 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009748 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009749 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009750 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009751 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9752 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009753 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009754 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9755 tcp-check expect string +OK
9756
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009757 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009758 (send many headers before analyzing)
9759 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009760 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009761 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9762 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9763 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9764 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009765 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009766
9767
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009768 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009769
9770
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009771option tcp-smart-accept
9772no option tcp-smart-accept
9773 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9775 yes | yes | yes | no
9776 Arguments : none
9777
9778 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9779 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9780 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9781 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9782 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9783 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9784
9785 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9786 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9787 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9788 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9789
9790 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9791 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9792 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009793 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009794
9795 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9796 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9797 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9798
9799 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9800 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9801 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9802
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009803 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9804
9805
9806option tcp-smart-connect
9807no option tcp-smart-connect
9808 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9810 yes | no | yes | yes
9811 Arguments : none
9812
9813 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9814 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9815 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9816 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9817 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9818
9819 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9820 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9821 complex.
9822
9823 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9824 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9825 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9826
9827 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9828 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9829
9830 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9831
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009832
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009833option tcpka
9834 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9836 yes | yes | yes | yes
9837 Arguments : none
9838
9839 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9840 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009841 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009842 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9843
9844 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9845 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9846 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9847 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9848
9849 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9850 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9851 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9852 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9853 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9854
9855 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9856
9857 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9858 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9859 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9860 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9861 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9862 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9863 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9864 backends.
9865
9866 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9867
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009868
9869option tcplog
9870 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009872 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009873 Arguments : none
9874
9875 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9876 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9877 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9878 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9879 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9880 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9881 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9882 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9883
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009884 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009886 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009887
9888
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009889option transparent
9890no option transparent
9891 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009893 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009894 Arguments : none
9895
9896 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9897 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9898 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9899 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9900 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9901 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9902 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9903 appropriate server.
9904
9905 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9906 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9907
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009908 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009909 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009910
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009911
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009912external-check command <command>
9913 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9915 yes | no | yes | yes
9916
9917 Arguments :
9918 <command> is the external command to run
9919
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009920 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9921
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009922 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009923
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009924 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9925 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9926 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9927 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9928 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9929 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009930
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009931 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9932
9933 Environment variables :
9934 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9935 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9936
9937 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9938
9939 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9940
9941 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9942 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9943 for a UNIX socket).
9944
9945 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9946
9947 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9948
9949 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9950
9951 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9952
9953 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9954
9955 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9956 socket).
9957
9958 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9959 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9960
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009961 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9962
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009963 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9964 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9965 failed.
9966
9967 Example :
9968 external-check command /bin/true
9969
9970 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9971
9972
9973external-check path <path>
9974 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9976 yes | no | yes | yes
9977
9978 Arguments :
9979 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9980
9981 The default path is "".
9982
9983 Example :
9984 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9985
9986 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9987 "external-check command"
9988
9989
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009990persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009991persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009992 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9994 yes | no | yes | yes
9995 Arguments :
9996 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009997 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9998 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009999
10000 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10001 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010002 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010003 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10004 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10005 forwarded to this server.
10006
10007 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10008 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10009 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010010 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010011 a single "listen" section.
10012
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010013 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10014 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10015 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10016
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010017 Example :
10018 listen tse-farm
10019 bind :3389
10020 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10021 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10022 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10023 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10024 persist rdp-cookie
10025 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010026 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010027 balance rdp-cookie
10028 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10029 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10030
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010031 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010032
10033
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010034rate-limit sessions <rate>
10035 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10037 yes | yes | yes | no
10038 Arguments :
10039 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10040 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10041
10042 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10043 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10044 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010045 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010046 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10047 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10048
10049 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10050 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10051 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10052 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10053
10054 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10055 listen smtp
10056 mode tcp
10057 bind :25
10058 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010059 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010060
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010061 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10062 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10063 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010064
10065 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10066
10067
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010068redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10069redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10070redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010071 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10073 no | yes | yes | yes
10074
10075 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010076 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010077
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010078 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010079 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010080 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10081 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10082 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010083
10084 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10085 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10086 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10087 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10088 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010089 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10090 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10091 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10092 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010093
10094 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10095 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10096 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10097 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10098 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10099 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010100 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010101 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010102 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10103 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10104 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010105
10106 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010107 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10108 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10109 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010110 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010111 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10112 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10113 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10114 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010115
10116 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010117 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010118
10119 - "drop-query"
10120 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10121 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10122 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10123 with a location-type redirect.
10124
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010125 - "append-slash"
10126 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10127 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10128 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10129 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10130
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010131 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10132 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10133 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10134 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10135 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10136 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10137 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10138
10139 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10140 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10141 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10142 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10143 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10144 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10145 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010146
10147 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10148 acl clear dst_port 80
10149 acl secure dst_port 8080
10150 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010151 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010152 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010153 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10154
10155 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010156 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10157 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10158 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010159 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010160
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010161 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10162 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10163 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10164
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010165 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010166 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010167
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010168 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010169 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10170 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10171 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010173 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010174
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010175
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010176retries <value>
10177 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10178 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10179 yes | no | yes | yes
10180 Arguments :
10181 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10182 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10183 default value is 3.
10184
10185 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10186 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10187 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10188
10189 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010190 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10191 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010192
10193 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10194 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10195
10196 See also : "option redispatch"
10197
10198
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010199retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010200 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10201 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10202 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10204 yes | no | yes | yes
10205 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010206 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10207 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10208 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10209 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10210 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010211
10212 none never retry
10213
10214 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10215 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10216
10217 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10218 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10219 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10220 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10221 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10222 processing the request.
10223
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010224 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10225 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10226 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10227 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10228 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10229 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10230 overflow attack for example).
10231
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010232 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10233 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10234 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10235 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10236 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10237 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10238 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10239 amplify denial of service attacks.
10240
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010241 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10242 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10243 considered to be safe to retry.
10244
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010245 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10246 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10247 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10248 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10249 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010250
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010251 all-retryable-errors
10252 retry request for any error that are considered
10253 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10254 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10255 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10256
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010257 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10258 not cumulative.
10259
10260 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10261 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10262 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10263 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10264
10265 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10266 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10267 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10268 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10269 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10270 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10271 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10272 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10273 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10274 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10275 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10276 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10277
10278 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10279 should not use this directive.
10280
10281 The default is "conn-failure".
10282
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010283 Example:
10284 retry-on 503 504
10285
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010286 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10287
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010288server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010289 Declare a server in a backend
10290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10291 no | no | yes | yes
10292 Arguments :
10293 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010294 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010295 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010296
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010297 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10298 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10299 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10300 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010301 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10302 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010303 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010304 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10305 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010306 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10307 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10308 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10309 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10310 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10311 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10312 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010313 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010314 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10315 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10316 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10317 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10318 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10319 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010320 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10321 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010322 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10323 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010324
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010325 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010326 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10327 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10328 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10329 adding this value to the client's port.
10330
10331 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10332 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010333 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010334
10335 Examples :
10336 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10337 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010338 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010339 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10340 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10341 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010342
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010343 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10344 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10345 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10346 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10347 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10348
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010349 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10350 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010351
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010352server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010353 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010354 this backend.
10355 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10356 no | no | yes | yes
10357
10358 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10359 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10360 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10361 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10362 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010363
10364 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10365 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10366
10367 global
10368 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10369
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010370 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010371 load-server-state-from-file
10372
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010373 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010374 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010375
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010376server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10377 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10378 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10380 no | no | yes | yes
10381
10382 Arguments:
10383 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10384
10385 <num | range>
10386 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10387 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10388 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10389 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10390
10391 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10392
10393 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10394
10395 <params*>
10396 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10397 keyword.
10398
10399 Examples:
10400 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10401 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10402 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10403
10404 # or
10405 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10406
10407 # would be equivalent to:
10408 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10409 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10410 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10411
10412
10413
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010414source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010415source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010416source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010417 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10419 yes | no | yes | yes
10420 Arguments :
10421 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10422 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010423
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010424 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010425 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10426 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10427 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10428 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10429 supported prefixes are :
10430 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10431 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10432 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010433 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010434 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10435 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010436
10437 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10438 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010439 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10440 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10441 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010442
10443 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10444 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10445 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10446 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10447 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10448 <addr>.
10449
10450 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10451 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10452 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10453 port.
10454
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010455 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10456 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10457 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10458 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010459 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010460 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10461 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10462 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10463 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10464 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10465 HTTP header.
10466
10467 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10468 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010469 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010470 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10471 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10472 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10473 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10474 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10475 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10476 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10477
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010478 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10479 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10480 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10481 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10482 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10483 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10484
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010485 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10486 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10487 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10488 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10489
10490 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10491 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10492 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10493 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10494 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10495 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10496
10497 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10498 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10499 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10500 there are two methods :
10501
10502 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10503 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10504 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10505 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10506 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10507 of the client ranges may be used.
10508
10509 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10510 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10511 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10512 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10513 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10514 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10515 same session.
10516
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010517 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10518 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10519 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010520 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010521
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010522 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10523
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010524 Examples :
10525 backend private
10526 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10527 source 192.168.1.200
10528
10529 backend transparent_ssl1
10530 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10531 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10532
10533 backend transparent_ssl2
10534 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10535 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10536 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10537
10538 backend transparent_ssl3
10539 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10540 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10541 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10542
10543 backend transparent_smtp
10544 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10545 # with Tproxy version 4.
10546 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10547
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010548 backend transparent_http
10549 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10550 # proxy.
10551 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010553 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010554 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10555
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010556
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010557srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10558 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10559 the connection on the server side.
10560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10561 yes | no | yes | yes
10562 Arguments :
10563 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10564
10565 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10566 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010567 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10568 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010569
10570 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10571
10572
10573srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10574 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10575 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10576 server side.
10577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10578 yes | no | yes | yes
10579 Arguments :
10580 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10581 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10582 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10583 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10584
10585 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10586 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010587 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10588 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010589
10590 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10591
10592
10593srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10594 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10596 yes | no | yes | yes
10597 Arguments :
10598 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10599 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10600 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10601 document.
10602
10603 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10604 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010605 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10606 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010607
10608 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10609
10610
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010611stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10612 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010614 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010615
10616 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10617 matched.
10618
10619 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10620 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10621
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010622 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10623 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010624 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010625
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010626 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10627 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10628 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10629 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010630
10631 Example :
10632 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10633 backend stats_localhost
10634 stats enable
10635 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10636
10637 Example :
10638 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10639 backend stats_auth
10640 stats enable
10641 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10642 stats admin if TRUE
10643
10644 Example :
10645 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10646 userlist stats-auth
10647 group admin users admin
10648 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10649 group readonly users haproxy
10650 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10651
10652 backend stats_auth
10653 stats enable
10654 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10655 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10656 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10657 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10658
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010659 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10660 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10661 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010662
10663
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010664stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10665 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010667 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010668 Arguments :
10669 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10670
10671 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10672
10673 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10674 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10675 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10676 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10677 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10678 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10679
10680 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10681 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10682 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010683 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010684
10685 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10686 report using "stats scope".
10687
10688 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10689 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10690 unobvious parameters.
10691
10692 Example :
10693 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10694 backend public_www
10695 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10696 stats enable
10697 stats hide-version
10698 stats scope .
10699 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010700 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010701 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10702 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10703
10704 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10705 backend private_monitoring
10706 stats enable
10707 stats uri /admin?stats
10708 stats refresh 5s
10709
10710 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10711
10712
10713stats enable
10714 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010716 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010717 Arguments : none
10718
10719 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10720 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10721 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10722 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10723 - stats auth : no authentication
10724 - stats scope : no restriction
10725
10726 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10727 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10728 unobvious parameters.
10729
10730 Example :
10731 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10732 backend public_www
10733 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10734 stats enable
10735 stats hide-version
10736 stats scope .
10737 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010738 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010739 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10740 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10741
10742 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10743 backend private_monitoring
10744 stats enable
10745 stats uri /admin?stats
10746 stats refresh 5s
10747
10748 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10749
10750
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010751stats hide-version
10752 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010754 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010755 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010756
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010757 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10758 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10759 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10760 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10761 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10762 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010763
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010764 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10765 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10766 unobvious parameters.
10767
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010768 Example :
10769 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10770 backend public_www
10771 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010772 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010773 stats hide-version
10774 stats scope .
10775 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010776 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010777 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10778 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010779
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010780 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10781 backend private_monitoring
10782 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010783 stats uri /admin?stats
10784 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010785
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010786 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010787
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010788
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010789stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10790 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10791 Access control for statistics
10792
10793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10794 no | no | yes | yes
10795
10796 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10797 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10798 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10799 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10800 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10801 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10802
10803 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10804 instance.
10805
10806 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10807 about ACL usage.
10808
10809
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010810stats realm <realm>
10811 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010813 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010814 Arguments :
10815 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10816 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10817 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10818
10819 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10820 using a backslash ('\').
10821
10822 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10823 only related to authentication.
10824
10825 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10826 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10827 unobvious parameters.
10828
10829 Example :
10830 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10831 backend public_www
10832 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10833 stats enable
10834 stats hide-version
10835 stats scope .
10836 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010837 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010838 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10839 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10840
10841 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10842 backend private_monitoring
10843 stats enable
10844 stats uri /admin?stats
10845 stats refresh 5s
10846
10847 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10848
10849
10850stats refresh <delay>
10851 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010853 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010854 Arguments :
10855 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10856 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10857 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10858 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10859 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10860 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10861
10862 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10863 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10864 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010865 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010866
10867 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10868 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10869 unobvious parameters.
10870
10871 Example :
10872 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10873 backend public_www
10874 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10875 stats enable
10876 stats hide-version
10877 stats scope .
10878 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010879 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010880 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10881 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10882
10883 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10884 backend private_monitoring
10885 stats enable
10886 stats uri /admin?stats
10887 stats refresh 5s
10888
10889 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10890
10891
10892stats scope { <name> | "." }
10893 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010895 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010896 Arguments :
10897 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10898 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10899 section in which the statement appears.
10900
10901 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10902 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10903 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10904 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10905 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10906 exists.
10907
10908 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10909 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10910 unobvious parameters.
10911
10912 Example :
10913 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10914 backend public_www
10915 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10916 stats enable
10917 stats hide-version
10918 stats scope .
10919 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010920 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010921 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10922 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10923
10924 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10925 backend private_monitoring
10926 stats enable
10927 stats uri /admin?stats
10928 stats refresh 5s
10929
10930 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10931
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010932
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010933stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010934 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010936 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010937
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010938 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010939 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10940
10941 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10942 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10943
10944 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10945 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010946 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010947
10948 Example :
10949 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10950 backend private_monitoring
10951 stats enable
10952 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10953 stats uri /admin?stats
10954 stats refresh 5s
10955
10956 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10957 global section.
10958
10959
10960stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010961 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10963 yes | yes | yes | yes
10964 Arguments : none
10965
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010966 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010967 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10968 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10969 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10970 - IP (socket, server)
10971 - cookie (backend, server)
10972
10973 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10974 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010975 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010976
10977 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10978
10979
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010980stats show-modules
10981 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10983 yes | yes | yes | yes
10984 Arguments : none
10985
10986 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10987 values as a tooltip.
10988
10989 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10990 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10991 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10992
10993 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10994
10995
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010996stats show-node [ <name> ]
10997 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010999 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011000 Arguments:
11001 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11002 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11003
11004 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11005 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011006 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011007
11008 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11009 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11010 unobvious parameters.
11011
11012 Example:
11013 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11014 backend private_monitoring
11015 stats enable
11016 stats show-node Europe-1
11017 stats uri /admin?stats
11018 stats refresh 5s
11019
11020 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11021 section.
11022
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011023
11024stats uri <prefix>
11025 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011027 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011028 Arguments :
11029 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11030 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11031 query string.
11032
11033 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11034 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11035 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11036 possible to reach it in the application.
11037
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011038 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011039 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011040 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11041 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11042 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11043 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11044
11045 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11046 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11047 an address or a port to statistics only.
11048
11049 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11050 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11051 unobvious parameters.
11052
11053 Example :
11054 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11055 backend public_www
11056 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11057 stats enable
11058 stats hide-version
11059 stats scope .
11060 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011061 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011062 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11063 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11064
11065 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11066 backend private_monitoring
11067 stats enable
11068 stats uri /admin?stats
11069 stats refresh 5s
11070
11071 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11072
11073
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011074stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11075 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011077 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011078
11079 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011080 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011081 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011082 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011083 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11084
11085 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11086 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11087 the "stick-table" statement.
11088
11089 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11090 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11091 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11092 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11093 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11094
11095 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11096 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11097 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11098 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11099 transformation rules.
11100
11101 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11102 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11103 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11104 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11105 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11106 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11107 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11108
11109 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11110 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11111 ACL based conditions.
11112
11113 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11114 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11115 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11116 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11117
11118 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11119 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11120 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11121 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11122
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011123 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11124 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011125 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011126
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011127 Example :
11128 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11129 # last 30 minutes
11130 backend pop
11131 mode tcp
11132 balance roundrobin
11133 stick store-request src
11134 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11135 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11136 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11137
11138 backend smtp
11139 mode tcp
11140 balance roundrobin
11141 stick match src table pop
11142 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11143 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11144
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011145 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011146 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011147
11148
11149stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11150 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11152 no | no | yes | yes
11153
11154 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11155 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11156 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11157 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11158
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011159 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11160 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011161 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011162
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011163 Examples :
11164 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011165 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011166
11167 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11168 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11169 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11170
11171
11172 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11173 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11174 backend http
11175 mode http
11176 balance roundrobin
11177 stick on src table https
11178 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11179 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11180 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11181
11182 backend https
11183 mode tcp
11184 balance roundrobin
11185 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11186 stick on src
11187 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11188 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11189
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011190 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011191
11192
11193stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11194 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11196 no | no | yes | yes
11197
11198 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011199 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011200 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011201 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011202 server is selected.
11203
11204 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11205 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11206 the "stick-table" statement.
11207
11208 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11209 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11210 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11211 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11212 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11213 address.
11214
11215 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11216 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11217 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11218 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11219 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11220 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11221 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11222 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11223 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11224 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11225
11226 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11227 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11228 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11229 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11230 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11231 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11232 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11233
11234 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11235 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11236 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11237 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11238
11239 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11240 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11241 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11242 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11243 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11244 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011245 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11246 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11247 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11248 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11249 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11250 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011251
11252 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11253 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11254 the request.
11255
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011256 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11257 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011258 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011259
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011260 Example :
11261 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11262 # last 30 minutes
11263 backend pop
11264 mode tcp
11265 balance roundrobin
11266 stick store-request src
11267 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11268 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11269 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11270
11271 backend smtp
11272 mode tcp
11273 balance roundrobin
11274 stick match src table pop
11275 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11276 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11277
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011278 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011279 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011280
11281
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011282stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011283 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011284 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011285 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011287 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011288
11289 Arguments :
11290 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11291 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11292 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11293 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11294
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011295 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11296 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11297 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11298 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11299
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011300 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11301 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11302 instance.
11303
11304 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11305 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11306 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11307 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11308 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11309 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011310 to 32 characters.
11311
11312 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11313 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11314 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011315 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011316 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11317 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011318
11319 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011320 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11321 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011322 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11323 increase.
11324
11325 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011326 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11327 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11328 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011329
11330 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011331 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011332 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11333 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011334 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011335 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11336 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11337 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11338 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11339 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11340 parameter (see below).
11341
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011342 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11343 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11344 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11345 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11346 soft restart.
11347
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011348 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11349 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011350
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011351 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011352 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11353 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011354 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11355 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011356 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011357 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011358 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11359 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011360 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11361 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011362
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011363 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11364 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11365 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11366 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11367 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11368 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11369 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11370 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11371 token.
11372
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011373 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11374 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11375 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11376 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011377 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11378 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11379 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11380 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11381 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11382 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11383 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11384 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11385 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11386 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11387 types and their arguments.
11388
11389 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11390 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11391 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11392 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11393
11394 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11395 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11396 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011397 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011398
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011399 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11400 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11401 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011402 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011403 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011404 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011405
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011406 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11407 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11408 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11409 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11410
11411 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11412 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11413 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11414 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11415 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11416 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11417
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011418 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11419 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11420 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11421 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11422
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011423 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11424 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11425 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11426 they were received.
11427
11428 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11429 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11430 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11431 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11432 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11433
11434 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11435 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11436 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11437 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11438 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11439
11440 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11441 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11442 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11443
11444 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11445 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11446 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11447 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11448 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11449
11450 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11451 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11452 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11453 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11454 the client side.
11455
11456 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11457 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11458 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11459 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11460 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11461 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11462 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11463
11464 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11465 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11466 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11467 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11468 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11469 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011470 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011471
11472 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11473 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11474 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11475 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11476 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11477 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11478
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011479 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11480 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11481 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11482 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11483 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11484
11485 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11486 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11487 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11488 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11489 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11490 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11491
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011492 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011493 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011494 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11495 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11496
11497 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11498 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11499 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11500 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11501 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11502 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11503 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11504 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11505 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11506 recommended for better fairness.
11507
11508 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011509 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011510 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11511 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11512
11513 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11514 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11515 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11516 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11517 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11518 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11519 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11520 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11521 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11522 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011523
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011524 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11525 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011526 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11527 reference it.
11528
11529 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11530 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011531 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11532 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11533 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011534
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011535 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11536 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11537 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11538 something that can be ignored.
11539
11540 Example:
11541 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11542 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11543 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11544 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11545
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011546 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011547 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011548
11549
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011550stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011551 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11553 no | no | yes | yes
11554
11555 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011556 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011557 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011558 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011559 server is selected.
11560
11561 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11562 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11563 the "stick-table" statement.
11564
11565 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11566 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11567 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11568 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11569
11570 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11571 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11572 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11573 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11574 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11575 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011576 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011577 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11578 rules.
11579
11580 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11581 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11582 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11583 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11584 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11585 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11586 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11587
11588 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11589 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11590 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11591 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11592
11593 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11594 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11595 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11596 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11597 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11598 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011599 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11600 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11601 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11602 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11603 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11604 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11605 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11606 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11607 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011608
11609 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11610
11611 Example :
11612 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11613 backend https
11614 mode tcp
11615 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011616 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011617 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011618
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011619 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11620 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011621
11622 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11623 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11624 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11625
11626 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11627 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011628
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011629 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11630 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11631 # at offset 44.
11632
11633 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011634 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011635
11636 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011637 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011638
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011639 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11640 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11641
11642 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11643 extraction.
11644
11645
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011646tcp-check comment <string>
11647 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11648 it fails.
11649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11650 yes | no | yes | yes
11651
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011652 Arguments :
11653 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11654 rule fails.
11655
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011656 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11657 user-friendly error reporting.
11658
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011659 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11660 "tcp-check expect".
11661
11662
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011663tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11664 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011665 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011666 Opens a new connection
11667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011668 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011669
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011670 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011671 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11672
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011673 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011674 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011675
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011676 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011677 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11678 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011679 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011680
11681 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011682
11683 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11684
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011685 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11686
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011687 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11688
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011689 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11690
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011691 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11692 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11693 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11694 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11695
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011696 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11697 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11698 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11699 haproxy -vv.
11700
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011701 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011702
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011703 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11704 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11705 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11706
11707 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11708 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11709 of the sequence.
11710
11711 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11712 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11713 do.
11714
11715 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11716 unset-var or comment rules.
11717
11718 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011719 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11720 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11721 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11722 option tcp-check
11723 tcp-check connect
11724 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11725 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11726 tcp-check send \r\n
11727 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11728 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11729 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11730 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11731 tcp-check send \r\n
11732 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11733 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11734
11735 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11736 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011737 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011738 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11739 tcp-check connect port 143
11740 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11741 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11742
11743 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11744
11745
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011746tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011747 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011748 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011749 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011750 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011751 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011753
11754 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011755 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11756
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011757 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11758 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11759 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11760 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11761 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11762 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11763 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11764 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11765 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11766 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11767
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011768 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011769 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11770 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011771 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11772 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11773 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11774
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011775 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11776 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11777 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011778 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11779 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011780 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11781 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011782 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11783 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011784 By default "L7OK" is used.
11785
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011786 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11787 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011788 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11789 supported :
11790 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11791 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011792 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11793 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11794 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11795 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11796 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011797
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011798 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011799 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011800 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11801 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11802 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11803 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011804 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11805
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011806 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11807 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11808 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11809 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11810
11811 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11812 informational message reported in logs if an error
11813 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11814 log-format string.
11815
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011816 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11817 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11818 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11819 followed by some converters.
11820
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011821 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11822 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11823 with the usual backslash ('\').
11824 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011825 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011826 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11827 used upper or lower case.
11828
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011829 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11830
11831 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11832 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11833 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11834 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11835 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11836 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11837 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11838 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11839
11840 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11841 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11842 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11843 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11844 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11845 expression.
11846
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011847 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11848 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11849 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11850 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11851 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11852 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11853
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011854 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11855 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11856 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11857 this exact hexadecimal string.
11858 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11859
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011860 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11861 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11862 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11863 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11864 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11865 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11866 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11867 size.
11868
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011869 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11870 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11871 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11872 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11873 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11874 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11875 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11876 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11877 in a binary string before matching the response's
11878 buffer.
11879
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011880 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011881 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011882 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11883 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11884 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11885 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11886 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11887 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11888 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11889 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11890 the null character.
11891
11892 Examples :
11893 # perform a POP check
11894 option tcp-check
11895 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11896
11897 # perform an IMAP check
11898 option tcp-check
11899 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11900
11901 # look for the redis master server
11902 option tcp-check
11903 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011904 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011905 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11906 tcp-check expect string role:master
11907 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11908 tcp-check expect string +OK
11909
11910
11911 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011912 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011913
11914
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011915tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11916tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11917 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11918 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011919 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011920 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011921
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011922 Arguments :
11923 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11924
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011925 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11926 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011927
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011928 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11929 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011930
11931 Examples :
11932 # look for the redis master server
11933 option tcp-check
11934 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11935 tcp-check expect string role:master
11936
11937 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011938 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011939
11940
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011941tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11942tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11943 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11944 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011946 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011947
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011948 Arguments :
11949 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011950
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011951 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11952 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011953
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011954 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11955 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11956 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011957
11958 Examples :
11959 # redis check in binary
11960 option tcp-check
11961 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11962 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11963
11964
11965 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011966 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011967
11968
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011969tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011970 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011971 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011972 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011973
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011974 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011975 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11976 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11977 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11978 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11979 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11980 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11981 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11982 and '-'.
11983
11984 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11985
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011986 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011987 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11988
11989
11990tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011991 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011993 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011994
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011995 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011996 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11997 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11998 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11999 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12000 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12001 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12002 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12003 and '-'.
12004
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012005 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012006 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12007
12008
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012009tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12010 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12012 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012013 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012014 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12015 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012016
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012017 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012018
12019 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12020 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012021 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12022 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12023 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12024 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12025 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12026 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012028 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12029 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12030 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12031 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012032
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012033 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012034 - accept :
12035 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12036 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12037 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012038
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012039 - reject :
12040 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12041 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12042 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12043 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12044 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12045 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12046 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12047 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12048 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12049 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12050 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012051 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012052
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012053 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12054 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12055 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12056 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12057 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12058 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12059 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12060 hosts.
12061
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012062 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12063 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12064 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12065 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12066 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12067 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12068 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12069 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12070
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012071 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12072 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12073 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12074 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12075 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12076 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12077 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12078 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12079 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012080 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12081 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012082
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012083 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012084 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012085 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12086 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12087 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012088 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012089 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012090 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12091 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12092 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12093 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12094 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12095 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12096 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012097
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012098 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012099 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012100 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012101 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012102 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12103 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12104 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012105
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012106 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12107 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12108 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12109 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012111 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12112 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12113 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12114 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12115 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012116 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12117 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12118 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12119 layer7 information is extracted.
12120
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012121 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12122 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12123 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12124 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12125 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012126
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012127 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12128 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12129 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12130 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12131
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012132 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12133 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12134 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12135 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12136
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012137 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12138 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12139 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12140 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12141 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012142
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012143 - set-src <expr> :
12144 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12145 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12146 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012147 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012148
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012149 Arguments:
12150 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12151 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012152
12153 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012154 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12155
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012156 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12157 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012158
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012159 - set-src-port <expr> :
12160 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12161 expression.
12162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012163 Arguments:
12164 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12165 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012166
12167 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012168 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12169
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012170 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12171 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12172 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012173
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012174 - set-dst <expr> :
12175 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12176 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12177 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12178 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12179 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12180
12181 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12182 followed by some converters.
12183
12184 Example:
12185
12186 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12187 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12188
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012189 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12190 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12191
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012192 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12193 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12194 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12195 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12196
12197
12198 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12199 followed by some converters.
12200
12201 Example:
12202
12203 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12204
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012205 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12206 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12207 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12208
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012209 - "silent-drop" :
12210 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012211 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012212 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12213 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12214 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12215 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12216 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012217 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12218 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012219 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12220 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012221 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012222 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12223 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12224 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12225 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012227 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12228 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12229 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012230
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012231 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12232 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12233 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012234
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012235 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012236 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012237 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012238
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012239 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12240 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12241 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012242
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012243 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012244 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12245 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012246
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012247 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12248
12249 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12250
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012251 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12252
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012253 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012254
12255
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012256tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12257 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012259 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012260 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012261 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12262 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012263
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012264 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012265
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012266 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012267 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12268 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012269 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12270 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012271
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012272 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12273 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12274 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12275 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012276 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012277 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012278 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12279 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12280 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12281 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012282 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012283 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012284
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012285 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12286 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12287 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12288 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012289
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012290 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012291 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012292 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012293 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12294 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012295 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012296 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012297 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012298 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012299 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012300 - set-dst <expr>
12301 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012302 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012303 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012304 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012305 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012306 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012307 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012308
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012309 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12310 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012311 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12312 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012313
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012314 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12315 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12316 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12317 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12318 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12319 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012321 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012322 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12323 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012324
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012325 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12326 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12327 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12328 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12329 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12330 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12331
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012332 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012333 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12334 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12335 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12336 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12337 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12338 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12339 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12340 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12341 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12342 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012343
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012344 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012345 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12346 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12347 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012348
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012349 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12350 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12351
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012352 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012353 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12354 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012355
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012356 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12357 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012358 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012359 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12360 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012361 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012362 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012363 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012364 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12365 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012366 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012367 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12368 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012369
12370 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12371 followed by some converters.
12372
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012373 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012374 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12375 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12376 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12377 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12378 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12379 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012380 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012381 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12382 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12383
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012384 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12385
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012386 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12387 <var-name>.
12388
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012389 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12390 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12391 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12392 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12393 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12394
12395 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12396 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12397 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12398 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12399 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12400 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12401 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12402 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12403 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12404 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12405 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12406
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012407 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12408 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12409 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12410 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12411 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12412
12413 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12414
12415 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12416
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012417 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12418 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12419 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12420 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12421 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12422 evaluated.
12423
12424 Example:
12425 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12426
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012427 Example:
12428
12429 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012430 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012431
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012432 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012433 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012434 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012435 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12436 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012437 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012438 tcp-request content reject
12439
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012440 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12441 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12442 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12443 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12444 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12445 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12446 ...
12447 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12448
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012449 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012450 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12451 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012452 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012453 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012454
12455 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12456 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012457 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012458 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012459 tcp-request content reject
12460
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012461 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012462 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012463 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012464 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012465 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12466 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012467
12468 Example:
12469 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12470 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012471 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012472
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012473 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012474 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012475
12476 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012477 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012478 # protecting all our sites
12479 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012480 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12481 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012482 ...
12483 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12484
12485 backend http_dynamic
12486 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012487 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012488 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012489 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012490 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012491 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012492 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012494 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012495
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012496 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12497 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012498
12499
12500tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12501 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012503 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012504 Arguments :
12505 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12506 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12507 as explained at the top of this document.
12508
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012509 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012510 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12511 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12512 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12513 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12514
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012515 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12516 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12517 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12518 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12519
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012520 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012521 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012522 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012523 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012524 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012525 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12526 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12527 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012528
12529 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12530 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12531 it pass through unaffected.
12532
12533 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12534 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12535 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012536 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012537 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12538 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012539 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12540 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12541 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012542
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012543 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012544 "timeout client".
12545
12546
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012547tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12548 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12550 no | no | yes | yes
12551 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012552 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12553 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012554
12555 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12556
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012557 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012558 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12559 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012560 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12561 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012562
12563 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12564
12565 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12566 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12567 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12568 inserted.
12569
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012570 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012571 - accept :
12572 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12573 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12574 the rules evaluation.
12575
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012576 - close :
12577 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12578 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12579 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12580 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12581 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12582 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012583 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012584 protocols.
12585
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012586 - reject :
12587 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12588 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012589 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012590
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012591 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012592 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012593
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012594 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12595 Unsets a variable.
12596
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012597 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12598 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12599 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12600 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12601
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012602 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12603 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12604 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12605 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12606
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012607 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12608 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12609 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12610 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12611 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012612
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012613 - "silent-drop" :
12614 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012615 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012616 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12617 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12618 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12619 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12620 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012621 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12622 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012623 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12624 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012625 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012626 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12627 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12628 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12629 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12630
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012631 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12632 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12633
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012634 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12635 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12636 for changing the default action to a reject.
12637
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012638 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12639 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12640 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12641 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012642 period.
12643
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012644 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12645 declared inline.
12646
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012647 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12648 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012649 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012650 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12651 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012652 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012653 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012654 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012655 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12656 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012657 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012658 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12659 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012660
12661 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12662 followed by some converters.
12663
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012664 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12665 <var-name>.
12666
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012667 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12668 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12669 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12670 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12671 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12672
12673 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12674
12675 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12676
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012677 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12678
12679 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12680
12681
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012682tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12683 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12685 no | yes | yes | no
12686 Arguments :
12687 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12688 below.
12689
12690 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12691
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012692 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012693 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12694 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12695 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12696 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12697 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12698 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12699 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012700 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012701 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12702 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12703 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12704 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12705 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12706 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12707 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12708 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12709 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12710 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12711 instead.
12712
12713 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12714 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12715 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12716 rules which may be inserted.
12717
12718 Several types of actions are supported :
12719 - accept : the request is accepted
12720 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12721 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12722 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012723 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012724 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012725 - set-dst <expr>
12726 - set-dst-port <expr>
12727 - set-src <expr>
12728 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012729 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012730 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012731 - silent-drop
12732
12733 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12734 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12735 sections for a complete description.
12736
12737 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12738 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12739 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12740
12741 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12742 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12743 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12744 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12745 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12746
12747 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12748 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12749
12750 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12751 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12752 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12753
12754 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12755 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12756 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12757
12758 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12759 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12760 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12761
12762 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12763 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12764 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12765
12766 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12767
12768 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12769
12770
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012771tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12772 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12774 no | no | yes | yes
12775 Arguments :
12776 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12777 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12778 as explained at the top of this document.
12779
12780 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12781
12782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012783timeout check <timeout>
12784 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12785 established.
12786
12787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12788 yes | no | yes | yes
12789 Arguments:
12790 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12791 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12792 as explained at the top of this document.
12793
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012794 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012795 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012796 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012797 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012798 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12799 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12800 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012801
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012802 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012803 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12804
12805 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12806 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012807 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012808
12809 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12810 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12811 forget about it.
12812
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012813 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12814 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012815
12816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012817timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012818 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12820 yes | yes | yes | no
12821 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012822 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012823 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12824 as explained at the top of this document.
12825
12826 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12827 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12828 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012829 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12830 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12831 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12832 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012833 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12834 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12835 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012836 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012837 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012838 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12839 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012840 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12841 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012842
12843 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12844 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12845 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12846 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012847 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012848 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12849
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012850 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012851
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012852
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012853timeout client-fin <timeout>
12854 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12856 yes | yes | yes | no
12857 Arguments :
12858 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12859 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12860 as explained at the top of this document.
12861
12862 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12863 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12864 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12865 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12866 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12867 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12868 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012869 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12870 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12871 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012872
12873 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12874 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12875 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12876
12877 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12878
12879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012880timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012881 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12883 yes | no | yes | yes
12884 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012885 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012886 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12887 as explained at the top of this document.
12888
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012889 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012890 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012891 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012892 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012893 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12894 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012895
12896 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12897 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12898 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12899 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012900 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012901 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12902
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012903 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012904
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012905
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012906timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12907 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12909 yes | yes | yes | yes
12910 Arguments :
12911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12913 as explained at the top of this document.
12914
12915 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12916 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12917 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12918 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12919 once the request has started to present itself.
12920
12921 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12922 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12923 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12924 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12925 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12926
12927 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12928 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12929 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12930 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12931
12932 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12933 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012934 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012935 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12936 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012937 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012938
12939 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12940 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12941 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12942 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12943
12944 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12945
12946
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012947timeout http-request <timeout>
12948 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012950 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012951 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012952 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012953 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12954 as explained at the top of this document.
12955
12956 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12957 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12958 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12959 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12960 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12961 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12962 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012963 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12964 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12965 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12966 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012967 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012968 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12969 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012970
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012971 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12972 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12973 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12974 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12975 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012976 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012977
12978 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12979 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012980 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012981 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12982 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12983
12984 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012985 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12986 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12987 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012988
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012989 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012990 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012991
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012992
12993timeout queue <timeout>
12994 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12996 yes | no | yes | yes
12997 Arguments :
12998 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12999 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13000 as explained at the top of this document.
13001
13002 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13003 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13004 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13005 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13006 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13007
13008 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13009 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13010 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13011 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13012
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013013 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013014
13015
13016timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013017 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13019 yes | no | yes | yes
13020 Arguments :
13021 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13022 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13023 as explained at the top of this document.
13024
13025 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13026 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13027 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13028 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13029 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13030 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13031 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13032
13033 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13034 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13035 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13036 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13037 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013038 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013039 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013040 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13041 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013042 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13043 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013044
13045 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13046 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13047 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13048 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013049 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013050 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13051
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013052 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013053
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013054
13055timeout server-fin <timeout>
13056 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13058 yes | no | yes | yes
13059 Arguments :
13060 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13061 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13062 as explained at the top of this document.
13063
13064 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13065 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13066 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13067 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13068 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13069 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13070 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13071 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13072 situations, it should not be needed.
13073
13074 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13075 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13076 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13077
13078 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13079
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013080
13081timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013082 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13084 yes | yes | yes | yes
13085 Arguments :
13086 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13087 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13088 as explained at the top of this document.
13089
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013090 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13091 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13092 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013093
13094 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13095 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13096 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13097 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013098 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013099
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013100 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013101
13102
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013103timeout tunnel <timeout>
13104 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13106 yes | no | yes | yes
13107 Arguments :
13108 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13109 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13110 as explained at the top of this document.
13111
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013112 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013113 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13114 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13115 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013116 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13117 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013118 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13119 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13120 specified.
13121
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013122 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13123 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13124 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13125 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13126 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13127 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13128 state.
13129
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013130 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13131 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13132 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13133 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013134 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013135
13136 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13137 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13138 forget about it.
13139
13140 Example :
13141 defaults http
13142 option http-server-close
13143 timeout connect 5s
13144 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013145 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013146 timeout server 30s
13147 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13148
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013149 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013150
13151
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013152transparent (deprecated)
13153 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013155 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013156 Arguments : none
13157
13158 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13159 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13160 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13161 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13162 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13163 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13164 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13165 appropriate server.
13166
13167 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13168
13169 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13170 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13171
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013172 See also: "option transparent"
13173
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013174unique-id-format <string>
13175 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13177 yes | yes | yes | no
13178 Arguments :
13179 <string> is a log-format string.
13180
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013181 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13182 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13183 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13184 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013185
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013186 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013187 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013188 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13189 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13190 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13191 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13192 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13193 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013194
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013195 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13196 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013197
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013198 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013199
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013200 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013201
13202 will generate:
13203
13204 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13205
13206 See also: "unique-id-header"
13207
13208unique-id-header <name>
13209 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13211 yes | yes | yes | no
13212 Arguments :
13213 <name> is the name of the header.
13214
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013215 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13216 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013217
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013218 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013219
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013220 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013221 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13222
13223 will generate:
13224
13225 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13226
13227 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013228
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013229use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013230 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13232 no | yes | yes | no
13233 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013234 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13235 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013236
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013237 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13238 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013239
13240 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13241 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13242 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013243 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013244 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013245 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13246 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013247
13248 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13249 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13250 assign the backend.
13251
13252 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13253 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13254 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13255 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13256 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13257 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13258
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013259 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013260 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013261 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13262 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13263 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13264
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013265 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13266 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13267 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13268 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13269 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13270 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13271 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13272 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13273 cannot be forced from the request.
13274
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013275 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013276 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13277 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13278
13279 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13280 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013281
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013282use-fcgi-app <name>
13283 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13285 no | no | yes | yes
13286 Arguments :
13287 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13288
13289 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013290
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013291use-server <server> if <condition>
13292use-server <server> unless <condition>
13293 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13295 no | no | yes | yes
13296 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013297 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13298 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013299
13300 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13301
13302 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13303 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13304 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13305
13306 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13307 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13308 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13309 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13310 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13311 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13312 matches will assign the server.
13313
13314 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13315 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13316 with the next rules until one matches.
13317
13318 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13319 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13320 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13321 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13322
13323 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13324 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13325 stripped.
13326
13327 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13328 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013329 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013330 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013331 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013332
13333 Example :
13334 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013335 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013336 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013337 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013338 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013339 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013340 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013341 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13342 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13343
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013344 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13345 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13346 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13347 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013348 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013349 and we fall back to load balancing.
13350
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013351 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013352
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133545. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013355--------------------------
13356
13357The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13358depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13359settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13360written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13361described in this section.
13362
13363
133645.1. Bind options
13365-----------------
13366
13367The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13368as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13369no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13370parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13371while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13372provided immediately after the setting name.
13373
13374The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13375
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013376accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13377 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13378 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13379 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13380 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13381 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13382 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13383 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13384 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13385 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013386 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13387 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13388 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013389
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013390accept-proxy
13391 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013392 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13393 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013394 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13395 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13396 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13397 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013398 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013399 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13400 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013401 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13402 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013403
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013404allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013405 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013406 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013407 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013408 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13409 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013410
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013411alpn <protocols>
13412 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13413 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13414 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013415 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013416 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013417 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13418 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13419 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13420 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13421 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13422 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13423 preference, like below :
13424
13425 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013426
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013427backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013428 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013429 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13430
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013431curves <curves>
13432 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13433 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13434 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13435 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13436 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13437 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13438
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013439ecdhe <named curve>
13440 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013441 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13442 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013443
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013444ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013445 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13446 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13447 client's certificate.
13448
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013449ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13450 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13451 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13452 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13453 error is ignored.
13454
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013455ca-sign-file <cafile>
13456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13457 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13458 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13459 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13460 'generate-certificates' for details.
13461
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013462ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013463 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13464 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13465 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13466 'generate-certificates' for details.
13467
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013468ca-verify-file <cafile>
13469 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13470 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13471 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13472 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13473 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13474
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013475ciphers <ciphers>
13476 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13477 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013478 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013479 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013480 information and recommendations see e.g.
13481 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13482 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13483 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13484
13485ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13487 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13488 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13489 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013490 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13491 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013492
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013493crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013494 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13495 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013496 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13497 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013498
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013499crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013500 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13501 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13502 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13503 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13504 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013505 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13506 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013507
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013508 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13509 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13510
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013511 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13512 are loaded.
13513
13514 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013515 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13516 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13517 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13518 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13519 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13520 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13521 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013522 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013523
13524 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13525 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13526 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13527 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013528 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13529 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013530
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013531 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013532
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013533 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013534 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013535 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13536 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013537 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13538 clients).
13539
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013540 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013541 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13542 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13543 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13544 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13545 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13546 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13547 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13548 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13549 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13550 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13551 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13552 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13553
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013554 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013555 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13556 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13557 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13558 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13559
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013560 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13561 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13562 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13563 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013564
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013565 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13566 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13567 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013568
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013569crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013571 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013572 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013573 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013574
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013575crt-list <file>
13576 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013577 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13578 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013579
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013580 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13581
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013582 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13583 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13584 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13585 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13586 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013587
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013588 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013589 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13590 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13591 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13592 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13593 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013594 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13595 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13596 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013597
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013598 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13599 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13600 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013601
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013602 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13603
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013604 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013605 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013606 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13607 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13608 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13609 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13610 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13611 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013612
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013613 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013614 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013615 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013616 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013617 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013618 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013619
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013620defer-accept
13621 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13622 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13623 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013624 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013625 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13626 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13627 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13628 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13629 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13630 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13631 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13632
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013633expose-fd listeners
13634 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13635 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013636 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13637 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013638 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013639
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013640force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013641 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013642 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013643 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013644 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013645
13646force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013647 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013648 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013649 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013650
13651force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013652 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013653 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013654 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013655
13656force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013657 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013658 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013659 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013660
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013661force-tlsv13
13662 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13663 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013664 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013665
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013666generate-certificates
13667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13668 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13669 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13670 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13671 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13672 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13673 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13674 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13675 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13676 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13677 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13678
13679 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13680 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013681 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013682 certificate is used many times.
13683
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013684gid <gid>
13685 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13686 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13687 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13688 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13689 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13690
13691group <group>
13692 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13693 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13694 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13695 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13696 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13697
13698id <id>
13699 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13700 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13701 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13702 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13703
13704interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013705 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13706 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13707 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13708 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13709 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13710 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013711 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13712 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13713 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13714 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13715 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13716 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013717
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013718level <level>
13719 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13720 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13721 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013722 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013723 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13724 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13725 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013726 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013727 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013728 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013729 all counters).
13730
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013731severity-output <format>
13732 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13733 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13734 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13735 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13736 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13737 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13738 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13739 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13740 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13741 rfc5424 convention.
13742
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013743maxconn <maxconn>
13744 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13745 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13746 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13747 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13748 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13749 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13750 eat all memory.
13751
13752mode <mode>
13753 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13754 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13755 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13756 UNIX sockets.
13757
13758mss <maxseg>
13759 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13760 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13761 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13762 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13763 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13764 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13765 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13766 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13767 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13768 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13769 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13770
13771name <name>
13772 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13773 page.
13774
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013775namespace <name>
13776 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13777 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13778 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13779 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13780
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013781nice <nice>
13782 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13783 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13784 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13785 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13786 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13787 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13788 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13789 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13790 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13791 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13792 one for an RDP socket.
13793
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013794no-ca-names
13795 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13796 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013797 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013798
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013799no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013801 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013802 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013803 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013804 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13805 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013806
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013807no-tls-tickets
13808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13809 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13810 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013811 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13812 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013813 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13814 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13815 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013816
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013817no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013819 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013820 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013821 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013822 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13823 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013824
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013825no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013826 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013827 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013828 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013829 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013830 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13831 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013832
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013833no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013834 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013835 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013836 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013837 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013838 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13839 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013840
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013841no-tlsv13
13842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13843 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13844 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13845 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013846 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13847 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013848
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013849npn <protocols>
13850 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13851 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13852 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013853 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013854 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013855 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13856 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13857 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13858 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13859 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013860
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013861prefer-client-ciphers
13862 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13863 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13864 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013865 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13866 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13867 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013868
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013869process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013870 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013871 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013872 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013873 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13874 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13875 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13876 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013877 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013878 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13879 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13880 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13881 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13882 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013883
13884 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13885
13886 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13887 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13888 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13889 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13890 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13891 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13892 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13893 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013894
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013895proto <name>
13896 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13897 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13898 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013899 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13900 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13901
13902 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13903 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13904 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13905 also reported (flag=HTX).
13906
13907 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13908 a bind line :
13909
13910 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13911 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13912 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13913
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013914 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013915 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013916 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013917 h2" on the bind line.
13918
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013919ssl
13920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013921 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013922 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13923 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013924 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13925 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013926
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013927ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13928 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013929 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13930 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13931 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013932 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13933
13934ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013935 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13936 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13937 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13938 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013939
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013940strict-sni
13941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13942 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13943 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13944 See the "crt" option for more information.
13945
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013946tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013947 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013948 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013949 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013950 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013951 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13952 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13953 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13954 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13955 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13956 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13957 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13958
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013959tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013960 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013961 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13962 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13963 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13964 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13965 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13966 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13967 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013968 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13969 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13970 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013971
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013972tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13973 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013974 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13975 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13976 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13977 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13978 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13979 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13980 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13981 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13982 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13983 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013984 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13985 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13986
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013987transparent
13988 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13989 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13990 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13991 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13992 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13993 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13994 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13995 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13996 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13997 so check for support with your vendor.
13998
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013999v4v6
14000 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14001 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14002 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14003 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014004 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014005
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014006v6only
14007 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14008 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14009 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014010 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14011 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014012
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014013uid <uid>
14014 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14015 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14016 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14017 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14018 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14019
14020user <user>
14021 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14022 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14023 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14024 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14025 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14026
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014027verify [none|optional|required]
14028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14029 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14030 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14031 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14032 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014033 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14034 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14035 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14036 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014037
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140385.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014039------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014041The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14042which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14043arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14044settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14045after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14046Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14047address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014049 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014050 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014051
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014052Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14053keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014055The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014056
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014057addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014058 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014059 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14060 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14061 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14062 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14063 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014064
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014065agent-check
14066 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014067 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014068 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14069 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14070 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014071
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014072 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014073 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014074 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014075 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14076 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014077
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014078 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14079 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14080 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14081 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14082 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014083
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014084 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014085 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014086
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014087 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14088 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14089 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014090
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014091 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14092 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14093 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014094
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014095 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014096 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14097 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14098 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14099 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014100 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014101 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014102
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014103 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14104 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014105
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014106 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14107 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14108 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14109 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14110 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14111 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14112 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14113 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14114 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014115
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014116 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14117 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014118 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14119 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14120 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014121 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014122
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014123 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014124 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014125
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014126agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014127 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014128 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14129 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14130 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14131 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14132
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014133agent-inter <delay>
14134 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14135 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14136
14137 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14138 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14139 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14140 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14141 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14142 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14143 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14144 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14145 of backends use the same servers.
14146
14147 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14148
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014149agent-addr <addr>
14150 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14151
14152 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014153 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014154 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14155 hostname, it will be resolved.
14156
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014157agent-port <port>
14158 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14159
14160 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14161
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014162allow-0rtt
14163 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014164 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14165 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014166
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014167alpn <protocols>
14168 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14169 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14170 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014171 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014172 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14173 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14174 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14175 now obsolete NPN extension.
14176 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14177 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14178
14179 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14180
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014181 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014183backup
14184 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14185 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14186 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14187 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014188 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14189 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014190
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014191ca-file <cafile>
14192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14193 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14194 server's certificate.
14195
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014196check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014197 This option enables health checks on a server:
14198 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14199 considered available.
14200 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14201 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14202 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14203 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14204 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14205 set.
14206 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14207 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14208 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14209 exchanges succeed.
14210
14211 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14212 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14213 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14214 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14215 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014216 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014217 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14218
14219 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14220 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14221
14222 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14223 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14224
14225 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14226 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14227 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14228 available.
14229
14230 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14231 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14232 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14233
14234 Example:
14235 # simple tcp check
14236 backend foo
14237 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14238 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14239 backend foo
14240 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14241 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14242 backend foo
14243 option tcp-check
14244 tcp-check connect
14245 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014246
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014247check-send-proxy
14248 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14249 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14250 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14251 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14252 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14253 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14254 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14255
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014256check-alpn <protocols>
14257 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14258 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14259 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14260
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014261check-proto <name>
14262 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14263 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14264 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014265 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14266 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14267
14268 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14269 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14270 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14271 also reported (flag=HTX).
14272
14273 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14274 directive on a server line:
14275
14276 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14277 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14278 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14279 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14280
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014281 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014282 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14283 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14284
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014285check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014286 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014287 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14288 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014289
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014290check-ssl
14291 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14292 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14293 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14294 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014295 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014296 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14297 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014298 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014299 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14300 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014301
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014302check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014303 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014304 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14305 for normal traffic.
14306
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014307ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14309 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14310 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014311 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14312 information and recommendations see e.g.
14313 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14314 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14315 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014316
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014317ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14319 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14320 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14321 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014322 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14323 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14324 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014325
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014326cookie <value>
14327 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14328 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14329 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14330 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14331 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14332 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14333 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14334
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014335crl-file <crlfile>
14336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14337 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14338 to verify server's certificate.
14339
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014340crt <cert>
14341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14342 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14343 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14344 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14345 certificate request.
14346
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014347 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14348 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14349 option is set accordingly).
14350
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014351disabled
14352 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14353 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14354 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14355 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14356 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014357 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014358
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014359enabled
14360 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14361 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14362 default value.
14363 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14364 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014365
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014366error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014367 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14368 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14369 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014371 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014372
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014373fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014374 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14375 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14376 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14377
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014378force-sslv3
14379 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14380 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014381 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014382 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014383
14384force-tlsv10
14385 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014386 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014387 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014388
14389force-tlsv11
14390 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014391 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014392 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014393
14394force-tlsv12
14395 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014396 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014397 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014398
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014399force-tlsv13
14400 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14401 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014402 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014404id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014405 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14406 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14407 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014408
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014409init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14410 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14411 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014412 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014413 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14414 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14415 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14416 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14417 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14418 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14419 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14420 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14421 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014422 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014423 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14424 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14425 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14426 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14427 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14428 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014429 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014430
14431 Example:
14432 defaults
14433 # never fail on address resolution
14434 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014436inter <delay>
14437fastinter <delay>
14438downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014439 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14440 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14441 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14442 between checks depending on the server state :
14443
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014444 Server state | Interval used
14445 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14446 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14447 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14448 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14449 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14450 or yet unchecked. |
14451 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14452 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14453 | "inter" otherwise.
14454 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014455
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014456 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14457 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14458 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14459 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014460 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14461 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14462 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14463 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14464 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014465
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014466log-proto <logproto>
14467 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14468 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14469 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14470 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014472maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014473 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14474 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014475 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14476 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014477 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14478 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14479 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14480 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14481
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014482 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14483 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14484 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14485 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14486 than 50 concurrent requests.
14487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014488maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014489 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14490 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14491 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14492 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014493 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14494 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14495 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14496 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14497 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14498 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14499 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014500
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014501max-reuse <count>
14502 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14503 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14504 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14505 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14506 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14507 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14508 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14509 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014511minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014512 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14513 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14514 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14515 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14516 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14517 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014518 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014519 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014520
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014521namespace <name>
14522 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14523 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14524 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14525 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14526
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014527no-agent-check
14528 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14529 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14530 default value.
14531 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14532 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14533
14534no-backup
14535 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14536 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14537 default value.
14538 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14539 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14540
14541no-check
14542 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14543 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14544 default value.
14545 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14546 "default-server" "check" setting.
14547
14548no-check-ssl
14549 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14550 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14551 default value.
14552 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14553 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14554
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014555no-send-proxy
14556 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14557 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14558 default value.
14559 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14560 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14561
14562no-send-proxy-v2
14563 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14564 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14565 default value.
14566 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14567 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14568
14569no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14570 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14571 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14572 default value.
14573 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14574 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14575
14576no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14577 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14578 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14579 default value.
14580 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14581 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14582
14583no-ssl
14584 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14585 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14586 default value.
14587 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14588 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14589
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014590 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14591 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14592 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14593
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014594no-ssl-reuse
14595 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14596 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14597 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14598 and for paranoid users.
14599
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014600no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014601 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14602 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014603 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014604
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014605 Supported in default-server: No
14606
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014607no-tls-tickets
14608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14609 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14610 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014611 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14612 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014613 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14614 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14615 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014616 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014617
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014618no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014619 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014620 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14621 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014622 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14623 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014624 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014625
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014626 Supported in default-server: No
14627
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014628no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014629 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014630 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14631 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014632 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14633 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014634 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014635
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014636 Supported in default-server: No
14637
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014638no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014639 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014640 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14641 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014642 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14643 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014644 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014645
14646 Supported in default-server: No
14647
14648no-tlsv13
14649 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14650 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14651 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14652 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14653 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014654 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014655
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014656 Supported in default-server: No
14657
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014658no-verifyhost
14659 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14660 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14661 default value.
14662 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14663 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014664
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014665no-tfo
14666 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14667 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14668 default value.
14669 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14670 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14671
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014672non-stick
14673 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14674 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14675 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14676
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014677npn <protocols>
14678 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14679 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14680 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014681 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014682 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14683 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14684 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014686observe <mode>
14687 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14688 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14689 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14690 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14691 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14692 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014693 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014694
14695 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014697on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014698 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14699 Currently, four modes are available:
14700 - fastinter: force fastinter
14701 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14702 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14703 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14704 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14705
14706 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14707
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014708on-marked-down <action>
14709 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14710 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014711 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14712 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14713 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14714 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14715 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14716 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14717 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14718 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014719
14720 Actions are disabled by default
14721
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014722on-marked-up <action>
14723 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14724 Currently one action is available:
14725 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14726 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14727 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14728 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014729 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14730 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014731 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14732 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14733
14734 Actions are disabled by default
14735
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014736pool-low-conn <max>
14737 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14738 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14739 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14740 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14741 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14742 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14743 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14744 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14745 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14746 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014747 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14748 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14749 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14750 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014751
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014752pool-max-conn <max>
14753 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14754 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14755 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14756 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14757 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14758 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14759
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014760pool-purge-delay <delay>
14761 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014762 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014763 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014765port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014766 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014767 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14768 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14769 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14770 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14771 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014772
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014773proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014774 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14775 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14776 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014777 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14778 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14779
14780 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14781 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14782 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14783 also reported (flag=HTX).
14784
14785 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14786 a server line :
14787
14788 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14789 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14790 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14791 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14792
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014793 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014794 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14795
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014796 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014798redir <prefix>
14799 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14800 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14801 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14802 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14803 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14804 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14805 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14806 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014807 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014808 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014809 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14810 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14811 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14812 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14813
14814 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014816rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014817 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14818 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14819 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14820
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014821resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14822 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14823 server.
14824
14825 Available options:
14826
14827 * allow-dup-ip
14828 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14829 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14830 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14831 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14832 For such case, simply enable this option.
14833 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14834
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014835 * ignore-weight
14836 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14837 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14838 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14839
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014840 * prevent-dup-ip
14841 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14842 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14843 same fqdn.
14844 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14845
14846 Example:
14847 backend b_myapp
14848 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14849 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14850 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14851
14852 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14853 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14854 it
14855 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14856 different address
14857
14858 Default value: not set
14859
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014860resolve-prefer <family>
14861 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14862 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14863 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14864 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14865
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014866 Default value: ipv6
14867
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014868 Example:
14869
14870 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014871
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014872resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014873 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014874 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014875 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014876 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14877 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014878 configured network, another address is selected.
14879
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014880 Example:
14881
14882 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014883
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014884resolvers <id>
14885 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14886 hostname.
14887
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014888 Example:
14889
14890 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014891
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014892 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014893
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014894send-proxy
14895 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14896 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14897 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14898 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014899 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14900 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14901 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14902 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014903 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014904 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14905 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14906 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14907 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14908 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014909 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14910 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014911
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014912send-proxy-v2
14913 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14914 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14915 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14916 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014917 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14918 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14919 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14920 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014921
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014922proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014923 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14924 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14925
14926 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14927 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14928 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14929 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14930 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14931 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14932 connection is supported).
14933 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14934 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14935 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14936 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14937 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14938 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14939 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014940
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014941send-proxy-v2-ssl
14942 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14943 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14944 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14945 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14946 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14947 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14948 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014949 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14950 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014951
14952send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14953 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14954 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14955 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14956 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14957 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14958 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14959 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14960 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014961 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14962 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014964slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014965 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14966 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14967 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14968 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14969 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14970 parameters :
14971
14972 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14973 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14974
14975 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14976 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14977 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14978 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14979
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014980 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014981 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14982 seen as failed.
14983
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014984sni <expression>
14985 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14986 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14987 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14988 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014989 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14990 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014991 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014992 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14993 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014994
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014995source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014996source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014997source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014998 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14999 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15000 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15001 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15002
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015003 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15004 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15005 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15006 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15007 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15008 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15009 server.
15010
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015011 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15012 specifying the source address without port(s).
15013
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015014ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015015 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15016 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15017 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15018 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15019 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15020 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015021 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15022 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015023
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015024ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15025 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15026 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15027 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15028
15029ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15030 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15031 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15032 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15033
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015034ssl-reuse
15035 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15036 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15037 default value.
15038 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15039 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15040
15041stick
15042 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15043 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15044 default value.
15045 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15046 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015047
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015048socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015049 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015050 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15051 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15052
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015053tcp-ut <delay>
15054 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015055 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015056 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015057 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015058 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15059 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15060 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15061 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15062 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15063 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15064 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15065 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15066 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15067
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015068tfo
15069 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15070 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15071 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15072 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015073 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015074 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015076track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015077 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15078 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15079 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15080 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015081 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15082
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015083tls-tickets
15084 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15085 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15086 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015087 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15088 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15089 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015090 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015091 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015092
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015093verify [none|required]
15094 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015095 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015096 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15097 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015098 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015099 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15100 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15101 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15102 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15103 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15104 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15105 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15106 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015107
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015108verifyhost <hostname>
15109 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015110 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15111 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15112 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15113 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15114 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15115 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15116 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15117 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015119weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015120 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15121 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15122 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015123 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15124 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15125 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15126 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15127 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15128 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015129
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015130ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15131 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15132 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15133 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15134
15135 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15136 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15137 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15138 server ALPN contains it.
15139
15140 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15141 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15142 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15143 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15144
15145 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15146 favor of the ALPN extension.
15147
15148 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015150
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151515.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15152-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015153
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015154HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15155using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015156configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015157This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15158can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15159workload.
15160This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15161resolution at run time.
15162Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15163carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15164
15165
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151665.3.1. Global overview
15167----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015168
15169As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15170different steps of the process life:
15171
15172 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15173 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15174 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15175
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015176 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15177 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015178
15179A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15180 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15181 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15182 resolution to know this new IP.
15183
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015184When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015185HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015186SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15187from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015188will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015189will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015190
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015191A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015192 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015193 first valid response.
15194
15195 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15196 servers return an error.
15197
15198
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151995.3.2. The resolvers section
15200----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015201
15202This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015203HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15204contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015205
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015206When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15207uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15208is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15209answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15210
15211When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015212used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015213
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015214 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15215 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15216 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015217
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015218 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15219 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015220
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015221 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015222 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15223 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015224
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015225For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15226following scenarios are possible:
15227
15228 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15229 ignored
15230
15231 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15232 applied
15233
15234 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15235 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15236
15237 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15238 retries the query with a new type
15239
15240 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15241 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015242
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015243As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015244a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015245<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015246
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015247
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015248resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015249 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015250
15251A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15252
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015253accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015254 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015255 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015256 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15257 by RFC 6891)
15258
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015259 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15260 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15261 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15262 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15263 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15264 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015265
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015266nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15267 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15268 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15269 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15270 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15271 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15272 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15273 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15274 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15275 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015276 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15277
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015278parse-resolv-conf
15279 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15280 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15281 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15282
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015283hold <status> <period>
15284 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15285 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015286 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015287 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015288 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15289 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15290 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15291
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015292 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015293
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015294resolve_retries <nb>
15295 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15296 giving up.
15297 Default value: 3
15298
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015299 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15300 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15301 type.
15302
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015303timeout <event> <time>
15304 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15305 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15306 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015307 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15308 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015309 Default value: 1s
15310 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015311 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015312 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015313 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15314 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15315
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015316 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015317
15318 resolvers mydns
15319 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15320 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015321 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015322 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015323 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015324 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015325 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015326 hold other 30s
15327 hold refused 30s
15328 hold nx 30s
15329 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015330 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015331 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015332
15333
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153346. Cache
15335---------
15336
15337HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15338(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15339RAM.
15340
15341The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15342this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15343
15344If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15345independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15346when we try to allocate a new one.
15347
15348The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15349
15350It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15351"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15352for more details.
15353
15354When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15355replaced by "<CACHE>".
15356
15357
153586.1. Limitation
15359----------------
15360
15361The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15362
15363- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015364- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15365 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15366 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015367- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15368- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015369- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15370 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15371 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015372- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15373 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015374- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15375 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15376 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015377
15378- If the request is not a GET
15379- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15380- If the request contains an Authorization header
15381
15382
153836.2. Setup
15384-----------
15385
15386To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15387the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15388
15389
153906.2.1. Cache section
15391---------------------
15392
15393cache <name>
15394 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15395 size of cache is mandatory.
15396
15397total-max-size <megabytes>
15398 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15399 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15400
15401max-object-size <bytes>
15402 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15403 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15404 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15405
15406max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015407 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015408 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15409 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15410 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15411 default.
15412
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015413process-vary <on/off>
15414 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015415 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15416 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15417 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015418 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015419
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015420max-secondary-entries <number>
15421 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15422 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15423 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15424
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015425
154266.2.2. Proxy section
15427---------------------
15428
15429http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15430 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15431 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15432 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15433 after this one.
15434
15435http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15436 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15437 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15438 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15439 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15440
15441
15442Example:
15443
15444 backend bck1
15445 mode http
15446
15447 http-request cache-use foobar
15448 http-response cache-store foobar
15449 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15450
15451 cache foobar
15452 total-max-size 4
15453 max-age 240
15454
15455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154567. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15457----------------------------------
15458
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015459HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15461The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15462these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15463but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15464data called patterns.
15465
15466
154677.1. ACL basics
15468---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015469
15470The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15471content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15472from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15473simple :
15474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015475 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015476 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015477 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15478 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015480The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15481adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015482
15483In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015485 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015486
15487This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15488Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15489and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015490an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15491conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15492as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15493are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015494
15495ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15496'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15497which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15498
15499There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15500performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015502The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15503specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15504this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015505methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15506ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507
15508Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15509 - boolean
15510 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15511 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15512 - string
15513 - data block
15514
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015515Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15516converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15517would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15518The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15519which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15520
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015521Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15522keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15523fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15524which are summarized in the table below :
15525
15526 +---------------------+-----------------+
15527 | Sample or converter | Default |
15528 | output type | matching method |
15529 +---------------------+-----------------+
15530 | boolean | bool |
15531 +---------------------+-----------------+
15532 | integer | int |
15533 +---------------------+-----------------+
15534 | ip | ip |
15535 +---------------------+-----------------+
15536 | string | str |
15537 +---------------------+-----------------+
15538 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15539 +---------------------+-----------------+
15540
15541Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15542matching method, see below.
15543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015544The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15545 - boolean
15546 - integer or integer range
15547 - IP address / network
15548 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15549 - regular expression
15550 - hex block
15551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015552The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15553
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015554 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15555 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015557 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015558 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015559 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015560 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015562The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15563read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15564if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15565lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15566will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15567beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015568a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15570exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15571
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015572The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15573parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15574ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15575a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15576check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15577
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015578The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15579socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15580file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015582Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15583loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15584
15585 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15586
15587In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15588the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15589case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15590as well.
15591
15592The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15593sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15594do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15595methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15596is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015597obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015598followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15599default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15600that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15601string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15602
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015603The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15604By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15605string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15606resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015607server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015608waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015609flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15610function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15613sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15614be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015615
15616 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15617 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015618 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15619 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15620 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15621 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015622
15623 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15624 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015626
15627 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015629
15630 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015632
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015633 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015634 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15635
15636 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15637 binary or string samples.
15638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15640 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015642 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15643 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15644 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015646 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15647 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15650 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15653 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15656 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015657 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15660 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15661 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015662
15663For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15664request, it is possible to do :
15665
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015666 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015667
15668In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15669buffer, one would use the following acl :
15670
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015671 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015672
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015673On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15674possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15675
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015676 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015678All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15679criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15680method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15681to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15682criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15683the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015686the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15687For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15690 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15691 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15692 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015693
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015694
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015695The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15696types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15697combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15698brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15699default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015701 +-------------------------------------------------+
15702 | Input sample type |
15703 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015704 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15706 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15707 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015708 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015710 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015712 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015714 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015716 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015718 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015720 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015721 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015722 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015724 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015726 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015728 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15730 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15731 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015732
15733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157347.1.1. Matching booleans
15735------------------------
15736
15737In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15738Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15739When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15740that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15741
15742Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15743return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15744"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15745
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157477.1.2. Matching integers
15748------------------------
15749
15750Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15751enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15752to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15753
15754Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15755matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15756lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015757
15758For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15759unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15760representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15761
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015762As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15763two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15764instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15765ranges and operators.
15766
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015767For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015768operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15769Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15770of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015771
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015772Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015773
15774 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15775 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15776 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15777 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15778 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15779
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015780For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015781
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015782 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015783
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015784This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15785
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015786 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015787
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157897.1.3. Matching strings
15790-----------------------
15791
15792String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15793different forms :
15794
15795 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015796 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015797
15798 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015799 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015800
15801 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15802 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15803
15804 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15805 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15806
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015807 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15809 matches.
15810
15811 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15812 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15813 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015814
15815String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15816exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15817characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15818string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15819to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015820before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015821
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015822Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15823(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15824Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15825
15826Example:
15827 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15828 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15829
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158317.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15832---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015833
15834Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15835they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15836possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15837passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15838the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015839the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15840match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015841
15842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158437.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15844-------------------------------------
15845
15846It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15847not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15848a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15849to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15850digits may be used upper or lower case.
15851
15852Example :
15853 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015854 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015855
15856
158577.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15858---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015859
15860IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15861netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15862within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015863host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015864difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15865at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15866does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15867parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015868
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015869The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15870abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15871
15872 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15873 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15874 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15875 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15876 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15877 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15878 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15879 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15880
15881Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15882192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15883
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015884IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15885Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15886trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15887IPv6 patterns.
15888
15889HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15890following situations :
15891 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15892 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15893 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15894 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15895 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15896 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15897 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15898 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15899 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15900 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902
159037.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15904----------------------------------
15905
15906Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15907combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15908
15909 - AND (implicit)
15910 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15911 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015913A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15918indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15921"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15922requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15923is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15924
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015925 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015926 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15927 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15928 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929
15930To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15931and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15932
15933 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15934 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15935 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15936 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15937
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015938 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015939 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15940 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15941 use_backend www if host_www
15942
15943It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15944expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15945be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15946the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15947
15948 The following rule :
15949
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015950 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015951 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952
15953 Can also be written that way :
15954
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015955 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956
15957It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15958to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15959simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15960sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15961good use is the following :
15962
15963 With named ACLs :
15964
15965 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15966 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15967 monitor fail if site_dead
15968
15969 With anonymous ACLs :
15970
15971 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15972
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015973See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15974keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975
15976
159777.3. Fetching samples
15978---------------------
15979
15980Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15981against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15982sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15983ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15984of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15985available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15986
15987This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15988Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15989compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15990deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15991
15992The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15993matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15994method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15995indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15996
15997As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15998when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15999mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16000the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16001ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16002
16003Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16004multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16005when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016006incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16007are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16009all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16010
16011Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16012 - name
16013 - name(arg1)
16014 - name(arg1,arg2)
16015
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016016
160177.3.1. Converters
16018-----------------
16019
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016020Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16021of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16022is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16023was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016024has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016025unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16026
16027These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16028sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16029the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016030support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016031
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016032A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16033support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16034supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16035(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16036bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016038The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016039
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001604051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16041 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16042 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16043 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16044 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16045 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16046
16047 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016048 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16049 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016050 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16051 frontend http-in
16052 bind *:8081
16053 default_backend servers
16054 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16055 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16056
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016057add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016058 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016059 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016060 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16061 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016062 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016063 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16064 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16065 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16066 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016067 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016068 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016069
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016070aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16071 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16072 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16073 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16074 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16075 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16076 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16077
16078 Example:
16079 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16080 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16081
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016082and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016083 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016084 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016085 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16086 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016087 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016088 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16089 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16090 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16091 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016092 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016093 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016094
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016095b64dec
16096 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16097 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016098 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16099 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016100
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016101base64
16102 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016103 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016104 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16105 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016106
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016107bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016108 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016109 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016110 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016111 presence of a flag).
16112
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016113bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16114 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16115 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016116 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016117
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016118concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16119 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16120 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16121 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16122 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16123 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16124 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16125 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16126 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16127 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16128 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016129 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016130 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016131 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16132 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016133
16134 Example:
16135 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16136 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16137 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016138 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016139 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16140
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016141cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016142 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16143 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016144
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016145crc32([<avalanche>])
16146 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16147 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16148 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16149 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16150 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16151 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16152 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16153 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16154 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16155 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016156 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16157
16158crc32c([<avalanche>])
16159 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16160 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16161 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16162 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16163 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16164 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16165 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16166 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016167
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016168cut_crlf
16169 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16170 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16171 updated.
16172
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016173da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016174 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16175 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16176 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16177 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016178 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016179 configuration language.
16180
16181 Example:
16182 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016183 bind *:8881
16184 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016185 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016186
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016187debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16188 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16189 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16190 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16191 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16192 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16193 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16194 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16195 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16196 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16197 printable sample types.
16198
16199 Example:
16200 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016201
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016202digest(<algorithm>)
16203 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16204 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16205
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016206 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016207 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16208
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016209div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016210 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16211 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016212 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016213 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16214 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016215 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016216 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16217 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16218 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16219 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016220 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016221 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016222
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016223djb2([<avalanche>])
16224 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16225 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16226 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16227 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16228 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16229 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16230 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016231 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16232 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016233
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016234even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016235 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016236 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16237
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016238field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16239 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16240 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16241 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16242 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16243 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16244 fields.
16245
16246 Example :
16247 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16248 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16249 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16250 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16251 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016252
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016253fix_is_valid
16254 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16255 Information eXchange):
16256
16257 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16258 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016259 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016260 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016261 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016262 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16263 checksum
16264
16265 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16266 the server can be parsed.
16267
16268 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16269 message, false if not.
16270
16271 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16272
16273 Example:
16274 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16275 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16276
16277fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16278 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16279 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16280 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16281 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016282 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016283 added.
16284
16285 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16286 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16287 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16288 fix_is_valid converter.
16289
16290 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16291
16292 Example:
16293 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16294 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16295 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16296 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16297 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16298
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016299hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016300 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016301 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016302 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016303 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016304
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016305hex2i
16306 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016307 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016308
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016309htonl
16310 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16311 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16312 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16313 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16314
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016315hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016316 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16317 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16318 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16319 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16320
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016321 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016322 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16323
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016324http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016325 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16326 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016327 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16328 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16329 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16330 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16331 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16332 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16333 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16334 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016335
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016336iif(<true>,<false>)
16337 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16338 string otherwise.
16339
16340 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016341 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016342
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016343in_table(<table>)
16344 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16345 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16346 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016347 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016348 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16349
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016350ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016351 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016352 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016353 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16354 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16355 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16356 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16357 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016358
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016359json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016360 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016361 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016362 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016363 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16364 of errors:
16365 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16366 bytes, ...)
16367 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16368 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16369
16370 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16371 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16372 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16373 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16374 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16375 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016376 - "ascii" : never fails;
16377 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16378 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016379 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016380 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016381 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16382 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16383
16384 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016385 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016386
16387 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016388 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016389 capture request header user-agent len 150
16390 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016391
16392 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16393 GET / HTTP/1.0
16394 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16395
16396 Output log:
16397 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16398
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016399json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16400 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16401 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16402 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16403 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16404
16405 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16406 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16407
16408 Example:
16409 # get a integer value from the request body
16410 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16411 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16412
16413 # get a key with '.' in the name
16414 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16415 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16416
16417 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16418 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16419
16420 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16421 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16422
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016423language(<value>[,<default>])
16424 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16425 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16426 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16427 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16428 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16429 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16430 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16431 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16432 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016433 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016434 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16435 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016436
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016437 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016438
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016439 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16440 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016441
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016442 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16443 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16444 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16445 use_backend spanish if es
16446 use_backend french if fr
16447 use_backend english if en
16448 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016449
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016450length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016451 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16452 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16453 type. The result is of type integer.
16454
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016455lower
16456 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16457 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16458 type. The result is of type string.
16459
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016460ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16461 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16462 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16463 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16464 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16465 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16466 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16467
16468 Example :
16469
16470 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016471 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016472 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16473
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016474ltrim(<chars>)
16475 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16476 representation of the input sample.
16477
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016478map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16479map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16480map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16481 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16482 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16483 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16484 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16485 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16486 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16487 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16488 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016489
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016490 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16491 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16492 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016493
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016494 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016495 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016496
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016497 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16498 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16499 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16500 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016501 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16502 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016503 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16504 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16505 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16506 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16507 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16508 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16509 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16510 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016511 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16512 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16513 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016514 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16515 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16516 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16517 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16518 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016519
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016520 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16521 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16522 the corresponding match text.
16523
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016524 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16525 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16526 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16527 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16528 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016529
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016530 Example :
16531
16532 # this is a comment and is ignored
16533 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16534 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16535 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16536 | | | `---------- value
16537 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16538 | `---------------------------- key
16539 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16540
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016541mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016542 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16543 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016544 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016545 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016546 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016547 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16548 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16549 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16550 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016551 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016552 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016553
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016554mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016555 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16556 <packettype>.
16557 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16558 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16559 from.
16560 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16561 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16562 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16563
16564 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16565 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16566 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16567 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16568
16569 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16570 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16571 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16572 packets only):
16573 17: Session Expiry Interval
16574 33: Receive Maximum
16575 39: Maximum Packet Size
16576 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16577 25: Request Response Information
16578 23: Request Problem Information
16579 21: Authentication Method
16580 22: Authentication Data
16581 18: Will Delay Interval
16582 1: Payload Format Indicator
16583 2: Message Expiry Interval
16584 3: Content Type
16585 8: Response Topic
16586 9: Correlation Data
16587 Not supported yet:
16588 38: User Property
16589
16590 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16591 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16592 packets only):
16593 17: Session Expiry Interval
16594 33: Receive Maximum
16595 36: Maximum QoS
16596 37: Retain Available
16597 39: Maximum Packet Size
16598 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16599 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16600 31: Reason String
16601 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16602 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16603 42: Shared Subscription Available
16604 19: Server Keep Alive
16605 26: Response Information
16606 28: Server Reference
16607 21: Authentication Method
16608 22: Authentication Data
16609 Not supported yet:
16610 38: User Property
16611
16612 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16613 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16614 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16615 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16616
16617 Example:
16618
16619 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16620 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16621 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16622 if data_in_buffer
16623 # do the same as above
16624 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16625 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16626 if data_in_buffer
16627
16628mqtt_is_valid
16629 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16630
16631 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16632 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16633 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16634 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16635
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016636 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16637
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016638 Example:
16639
16640 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016641 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016642
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016643mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016644 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016645 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16646 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016647 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016648 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016649 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016650 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16651 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16652 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16653 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016654 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016655 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016656
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016657nbsrv
16658 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16659 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16660 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16661 map lookup.
16662
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016663neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016664 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16665 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16666 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16667 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016668
16669not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016670 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016671 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016672 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016673 absence of a flag).
16674
16675odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016676 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016677 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16678
16679or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016680 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016681 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016682 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16683 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016684 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016685 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16686 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16687 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16688 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016689 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016690 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016691
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016692protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16693 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16694 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16695 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16696 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16697 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16698 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16699 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16700 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16701 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16702 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16703 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16704
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016705regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016706 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16707 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16708 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16709 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16710 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16711 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16712 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16713 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16714 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016715 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16716 of characters with other ones.
16717
16718 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16719 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16720 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16721 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16722 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16723 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016724
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016725 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016726
16727 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16728 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16729 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016730 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016731
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016732 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16733 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16734
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016735 # capture groups and backreferences
16736 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016737 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016738 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16739
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016740capture-req(<id>)
16741 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16742 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16743
16744 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016745 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16746 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016747
16748capture-res(<id>)
16749 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16750 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16751
16752 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016753 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16754 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016755
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016756rtrim(<chars>)
16757 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16758 of the input sample.
16759
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016760sdbm([<avalanche>])
16761 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16762 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16763 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16764 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16765 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16766 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16767 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016768 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16769 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016770
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016771secure_memcmp(<var>)
16772 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16773 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16774 match.
16775
16776 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16777 performed in constant time.
16778
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016779 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016780 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16781
16782 Example :
16783
16784 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16785 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16786 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16787 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16788
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016789set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016790 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16791 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16792 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016793 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016794 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16795 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016796 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016797 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16798 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016799 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016800 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016801
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016802sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016803 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016804 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16805
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016806sha2([<bits>])
16807 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16808 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16809
16810 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16811 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16812
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016813 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016814 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16815
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016816srv_queue
16817 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16818 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16819 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16820 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16821 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16822
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016823strcmp(<var>)
16824 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16825 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16826 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16827 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16828 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16829 shorter).
16830
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016831 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16832 strings in constant time.
16833
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016834 Example :
16835
16836 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16837 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16838 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16839
16840
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016841sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016842 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16843 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016844 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016845 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16846 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016847 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016848 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16849 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016850 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016851 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16852 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016853 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016854 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016855
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016856table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16857 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16858 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16859 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16860 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16861 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16862 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16863
16864
16865table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16869 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16870 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16871 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16872
16873table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16874 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16875 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016876 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016877 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16878 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16879
16880table_conn_cur(<table>)
16881 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16882 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16883 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16884 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16885 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16886
16887table_conn_rate(<table>)
16888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16891 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16892 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16893
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016894table_gpt0(<table>)
16895 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16896 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16897 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16898 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16899 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16900
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016901table_gpc0(<table>)
16902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16904 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16905 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16906 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16907
16908table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16909 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16910 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16911 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16912 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16913 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16914 sample fetch keyword.
16915
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016916table_gpc1(<table>)
16917 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16918 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16919 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16920 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16921 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16922
16923table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16924 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16925 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16926 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16927 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16928 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16929 sample fetch keyword.
16930
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016931table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16932 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16933 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016934 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016935 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16936 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16937
16938table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16939 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16940 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16941 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16942 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16943 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16944 keyword.
16945
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016946table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16947 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16948 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16949 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16950 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16951 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16952
16953table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16954 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16955 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16956 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16957 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16958 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16959 keyword.
16960
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016961table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16962 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16963 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016964 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016965 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16966 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16967
16968table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16969 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16970 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16971 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16972 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16973 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16974 keyword.
16975
16976table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16977 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16978 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016979 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016980 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16981 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16982 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16983 keyword.
16984
16985table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16986 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16987 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016988 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016989 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16990 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16991 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16992 keyword.
16993
16994table_server_id(<table>)
16995 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16996 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16997 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16998 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16999 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17000 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17001
17002table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17003 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17004 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017005 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017006 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17007 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17008 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17009 keyword.
17010
17011table_sess_rate(<table>)
17012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17014 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17015 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17016 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17017 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17018 keyword.
17019
17020table_trackers(<table>)
17021 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17022 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17023 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17024 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17025 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17026 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17027 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17028 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17029 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17030 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17031
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017032ub64dec
17033 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17034 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17035 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17036
17037 Example:
17038 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17039 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17040
17041ub64enc
17042 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17043
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017044upper
17045 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17046 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17047 type. The result is of type string.
17048
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017049url_dec([<in_form>])
17050 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17051 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17052 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17053 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17054 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17055 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017056
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017057url_enc([<enc_type>])
17058 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17059 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17060 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17061 optional argument is here for future changes.
17062
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017063ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017064 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017065 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17066 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17067 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017068 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17069 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17070 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17071 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017072 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017073 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17074 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017075
17076 Example:
17077 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17078 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17079
17080 message Point {
17081 int32 latitude = 1;
17082 int32 longitude = 2;
17083 }
17084
17085 message PPoint {
17086 Point point = 59;
17087 }
17088
17089 message Rectangle {
17090 // One corner of the rectangle.
17091 PPoint lo = 48;
17092 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17093 PPoint hi = 49;
17094 }
17095
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017096 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17097 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17098 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017099
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017100 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17101 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017102 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017103 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17104
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017105 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017106
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017107 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017108
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017109 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17110 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17111 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017112
17113 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17114 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17115 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17116
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017117 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17118 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17119 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017120
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017121
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017122unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017123 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17124 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17125 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17126 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17127 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17128 response),
17129 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17130 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17131 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17132 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17133
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017134utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17135 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17136 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17137 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17138 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17139 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17140 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17141
17142 Example :
17143
17144 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017145 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017146 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17147
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017148word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17149 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17150 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17151 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017152 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017153 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17154 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17155
17156 Example :
17157 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17158 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17159 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17160 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17161 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017162 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017163
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017164wt6([<avalanche>])
17165 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17166 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17167 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17168 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17169 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17170 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17171 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017172 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17173 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017174
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017175xor(<value>)
17176 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017177 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017178 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017179 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017180 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017181 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17182 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017183 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017184 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17185 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017186 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017187 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017188
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017189xxh3([<seed>])
17190 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17191 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17192 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17193 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17194 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17195 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17196 considered as cryptographically secure.
17197
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017198xxh32([<seed>])
17199 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17200 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17201 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17202 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17203 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17204 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17205 as cryptographically secure.
17206
17207xxh64([<seed>])
17208 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17209 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17210 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17211 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17212 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17213 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17214 as cryptographically secure.
17215
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017216
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172177.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017218--------------------------------------------
17219
17220A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17221not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17222"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17223The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17224
17225always_false : boolean
17226 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17227 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17228
17229always_true : boolean
17230 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17231 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17232
17233avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017234 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017235 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17236 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17237 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17238 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17239 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17240 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17241 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17242 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17243 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17244 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17245 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17246 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17247 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017249be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017250 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17251 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17252 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17253 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017254 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17255
17256be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17257 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17258 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17259 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17260 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17261 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017262 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17263 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017264
17265 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17266 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17267 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017269be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17270 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17271 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17272 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017273 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017274 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17275 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017276
17277 Example :
17278 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17279 backend dynamic
17280 mode http
17281 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17282 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017284bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017285 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17286 of the string.
17287
17288bool(<bool>) : bool
17289 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17290 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017292connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17293 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017294 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017295 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17296 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017297
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017298 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017299 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017300 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17301
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017302 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17303 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017304
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017305 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017306 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017307 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017308 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017309 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017310 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017311 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017312
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017313 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17314 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017315 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017316 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017317
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017318cpu_calls : integer
17319 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17320 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17321 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17322 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17323 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17324 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17325
17326cpu_ns_avg : integer
17327 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17328 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17329 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17330 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17331 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17332 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17333 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17334 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17335 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17336 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17337 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17338
17339cpu_ns_tot : integer
17340 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17341 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17342 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17343 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17344 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17345 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17346 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17347 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17348 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17349 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17350 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17351 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17352 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17353
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017354date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017355 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017356
17357 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17358 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17359 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017360 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17361
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017362 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17363 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17364 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17365 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17366 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17367
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017368 Example :
17369
17370 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17371 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017372
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017373 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17374 # millisecond granularity
17375 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17376
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017377date_us : integer
17378 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17379 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17380 from the same timeval structure.
17381
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017382distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17383 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17384 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17385 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17386 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017387 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017388 list of supported tokens.
17389
17390distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17391 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17392 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17393 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17394 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017395 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017396 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17397 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17398 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17399 supported tokens.
17400
17401 Example :
17402 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17403 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17404 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17405 # send large files to the big farm
17406 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17407
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017408env(<name>) : string
17409 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17410 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17411 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17412 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17413 certain way.
17414
17415 Examples :
17416 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17417 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17418
17419 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017420 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017422fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17423 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017424 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17425 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017426 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17427 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017428 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017429 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17430 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017431
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017432fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17433 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17434 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17435 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17438 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17439 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17440 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17441 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17442 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17443 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17444 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17445 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017446
17447 Example :
17448 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17449 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17450 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17451 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17452 frontend mail
17453 bind :25
17454 mode tcp
17455 maxconn 100
17456 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17457 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17458 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17459 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017460
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017461hostname : string
17462 Returns the system hostname.
17463
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017464int(<integer>) : signed integer
17465 Returns a signed integer.
17466
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017467ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17468 Returns an ipv4.
17469
17470ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17471 Returns an ipv6.
17472
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017473lat_ns_avg : integer
17474 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17475 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17476 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17477 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17478 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17479 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17480 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17481 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17482 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017483 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17484 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17485 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17486 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17487 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17488 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017489
17490lat_ns_tot : integer
17491 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17492 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17493 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17494 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17495 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17496 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17497 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17498 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17499 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017500 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17501 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17502 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17503 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17504 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017505 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17506 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17507 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17508 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17509 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17510 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17511
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017512meth(<method>) : method
17513 Returns a method.
17514
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017515nbproc : integer
17516 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17517 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17518 and debugging purposes.
17519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017520nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17521 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17522 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17523 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017524 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17525 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17526 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017527
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017528prio_class : integer
17529 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17530 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17531 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17532
17533prio_offset : integer
17534 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17535 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17536 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17537 set-priority-offset".
17538
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017539proc : integer
17540 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17541 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17542 debugging purposes.
17543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017544queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017545 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17546 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17547 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017548 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17549 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17550 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17551 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17552 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17553
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017554rand([<range>]) : integer
17555 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17556 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17557 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17558 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17559 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017561srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17562 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17563 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17564 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17565 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17566 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017567 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17568 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17569
17570srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17571 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17572 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17573 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17574 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17575 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17576 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17577 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17578
17579 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17580 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017581
17582srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17583 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17584 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17585 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017586 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017587 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17588 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17589 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17590
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017591srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17592 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17593 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17594 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17595 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17596 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17597 fetch methods.
17598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017599srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17600 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17601 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017602 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017603 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17604 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017605 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606 overloading servers).
17607
17608 Example :
17609 # Redirect to a separate back
17610 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17611 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17612 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17613
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017614srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017615 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17616 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17617 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17618
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017619srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017620 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17621 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17622 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17623
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017624srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017625 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17626 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17627 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17628
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017629stopping : boolean
17630 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17631 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17632 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17633
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017634str(<string>) : string
17635 Returns a string.
17636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017637table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17638 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17639 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17640
17641table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17642 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17643 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17644 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17645
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017646thread : integer
17647 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17648 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17649 and debugging purposes.
17650
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017651uuid([<version>]) : string
17652 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17653 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17654 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17655
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017656var(<var-name>) : undefined
17657 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017658 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17659 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017660 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017661 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17662 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017663 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017664 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17665 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017666 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017667 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017668
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176697.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017670----------------------------------
17671
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017672The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017673closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17674methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17675sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17676TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017677the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17678counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017679"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17680used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17681can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17682Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17683table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17684tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17685currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017686
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017687bc_dst : ip
17688 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17689 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17690 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17691 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17692
17693bc_dst_port : integer
17694 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017695 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017696
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017697bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017698 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17699 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17700 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17701
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017702bc_src : ip
17703 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017704 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017705 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17706 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17707
17708bc_src_port : integer
17709 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017710 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017712be_id : integer
17713 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017714 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17715 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017716
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017717be_name : string
17718 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017719 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17720 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017721
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017722be_server_timeout : integer
17723 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17724 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17725 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17726
17727be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17728 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17729 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17730 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17731
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017732cur_server_timeout : integer
17733 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17734 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17735 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17736
17737cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17738 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17739 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17740 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017742dst : ip
17743 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17744 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17745 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17746 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017747 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17748 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17749 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17750 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17751 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17752 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017753
17754dst_conn : integer
17755 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17756 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17757 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17758 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17759 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17760 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17761 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17762 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017763
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017764dst_is_local : boolean
17765 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17766 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17767 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17768 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017769 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017770 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17771 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17772 it only once per connection.
17773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017774dst_port : integer
17775 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17776 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17777 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17778 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17779 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17780 an HTTP header.
17781
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017782fc_fackets : integer
17783 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17784 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17785 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17786 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17787
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017788fc_http_major : integer
17789 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17790 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17791 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17792
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017793fc_lost : integer
17794 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17795 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17796 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17797 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17798
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017799fc_pp_authority : string
17800 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17801 if any.
17802
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017803fc_pp_unique_id : string
17804 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17805 if any.
17806
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017807fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17808 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17809 header.
17810
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017811fc_reordering : integer
17812 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17813 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17814 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17815 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17816
17817fc_retrans : integer
17818 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17819 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17820 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17821 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17822
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017823fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17824 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17825 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17826 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17827 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17828 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17829 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17830
17831fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17832 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17833 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17834 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17835 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17836 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17837 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17838
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017839fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017840 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17841 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17842 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17843 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17844
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017845
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017846fc_unacked : integer
17847 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17848 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17849 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17850 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017851
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017852fe_defbe : string
17853 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17854 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017856fe_id : integer
17857 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017858 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017859 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17860
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017861fe_name : string
17862 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17863 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17864 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17865
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017866fe_client_timeout : integer
17867 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17868 current frontend.
17869
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017870sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017871sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17872sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17873sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017874 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17875 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17876 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17877
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017878sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017879sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17880sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17881sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017882 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17883 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17884 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17885
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017886sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017887sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17888sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17889sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017890 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17891 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017892 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17893 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17894 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017895
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017896 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017897 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17898 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017899 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17900 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17901 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017902 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17903 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17904
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017905sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17906sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17907sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17908sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17909 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17910 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17911 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17912 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17913 when a first ACL was verified.
17914
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017915sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017916sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17917sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17918sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017919 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017920 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17921
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017922sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017923sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17924sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17925sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017926 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17927 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17928 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017930sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017931sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17932sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17933sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017934 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17935 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17936 See also src_conn_rate.
17937
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017938sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017939sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17940sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17941sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017942 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017943 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017944
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017945sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17946sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17947sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17948sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17949 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17950 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17951
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017952sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17953sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17954sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17955sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17956 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17957 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17958
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017959sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017960sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17961sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17962sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017963 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17964 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17965 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017966 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17967 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17968 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017969
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017970sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17971sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17972sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17973sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17974 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17975 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17976 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17977 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17978 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17979 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17980
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017981sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017982sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17983sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17984sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017985 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017986 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17987 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17988
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017989sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017990sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17991sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17992sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017993 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17994 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17995 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17996 src_http_err_rate.
17997
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017998sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17999sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18000sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18001sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18002 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18003 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18004 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18005
18006sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18007sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18008sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18009sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18010 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18011 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18012 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18013 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18014
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018015sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018016sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18017sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18018sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018019 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018020 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18021 src_http_req_cnt.
18022
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018023sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018024sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18025sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18026sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018027 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18028 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18029 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18030 src_http_req_rate.
18031
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018032sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018033sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18034sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18035sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018036 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018037 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18038 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18039 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18040 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018041
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018042 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018043 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18044 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018045 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18046
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018047sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18048sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18049sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18050sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18051 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18052 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18053 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18054 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18055 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18056
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018057sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018058sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18059sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18060sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018061 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18062 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18063 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018064
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018065sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018066sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18067sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18068sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018069 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18070 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18071 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018072
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018073sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018074sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18075sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18076sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018077 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018078 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18079 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18080 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018081 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018082 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18083
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018084sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018085sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18086sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18087sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018088 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18089 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18090 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18091 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18092 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018093 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018094
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018095sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018096sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18097sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18098sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018099 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18100 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18101 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18102
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018103sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018104sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18105sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18106sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018107 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18108 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018109 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018110 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18111 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018112 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18113 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18114 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018116so_id : integer
18117 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18118 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18119 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018120
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018121so_name : string
18122 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18123 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18124 strings instead of integers.
18125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018126src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018127 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018128 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18129 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18130 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018131 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18132 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18133 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018134 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18135 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18136 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18137 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18138 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18139 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18140 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018141
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018142 Example:
18143 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18144 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018146src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18147 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18148 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18149 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018150 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018152src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18153 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18154 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018155 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018156 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018158src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18159 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18160 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18161 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18162 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18163 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18164 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018165
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018166 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018167 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18168 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18169 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18170 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018171 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018172 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18173 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18174
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018175src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18176 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18177 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18178 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18179 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18180 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18181 was verified.
18182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018183src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018184 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018185 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018186 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018187 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018189src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018190 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018191 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18192 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018193 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018195src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18196 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18197 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18198 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018199 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018201src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018202 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018203 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018204 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018205 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018206
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018207src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18208 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18209 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18210 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18211 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18212
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018213src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18214 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18215 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18216 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18217 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018219src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018220 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018221 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018222 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18223 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018224 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18225 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18226 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018227
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018228src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18229 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18230 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18231 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18232 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18233 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18234 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18235 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018237src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018238 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018239 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018240 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018241 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018242 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018244src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18245 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18246 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18247 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18248 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018249 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018250
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018251src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18252 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18253 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018254 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018255 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18256 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18257
18258src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18259 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18260 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18261 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18262 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18263 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18264 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018266src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018267 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018268 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18269 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018270 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018272src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18273 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18274 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18275 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018276 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018277 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018279src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18280 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18281 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18282 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018283 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018284 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18285 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018286
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018287 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018288 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018289 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018290 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018291
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018292src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18293 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18294 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18295 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18296 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18297 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18298 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18299
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018300src_is_local : boolean
18301 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18302 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18303 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18304 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018305 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018306 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18307 once per connection.
18308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018309src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018310 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18311 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18312 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18313 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18314 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018316src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018317 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18318 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18319 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18320 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18321 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018323src_port : integer
18324 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18325 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18326 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18327 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018329src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018330 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018331 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18332 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18333 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018334 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18337 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18338 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18339 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18340 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018341 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018343src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18344 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18345 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18346 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18347 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18348 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18349 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18350 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18351 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018352
18353 Example :
18354 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18355 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18356 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18357 listen ssh
18358 bind :22
18359 mode tcp
18360 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018361 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018362 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018363 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018365srv_id : integer
18366 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18367 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018368 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018369
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018370srv_name : string
18371 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18372 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018373 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018374
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200183757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018376----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018377
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018378The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018379closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18380when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18381usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018382future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018383
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001838451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18385 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18386 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18387 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18388 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18389 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18390
18391 Example :
18392 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18393 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18394 # the request.
18395 frontend http-in
18396 bind *:8081
18397 default_backend servers
18398 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18399 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18400
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018401ssl_bc : boolean
18402 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18403 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018404 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18405 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018406
18407ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18408 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018409 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18410 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018411
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018412ssl_bc_alpn : string
18413 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18414 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018415 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018416 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18417 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18418 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18419 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18420 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018421 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18422 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018423
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018424ssl_bc_cipher : string
18425 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018426 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18427 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018428
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018429ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18430 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18431 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18432 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018433 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018434
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018435ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18436 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18437 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018438 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18439 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018440
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018441ssl_bc_npn : string
18442 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18443 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018444 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018445 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18446 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18447 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18448 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018449 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18450 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018451
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018452ssl_bc_protocol : string
18453 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018454 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18455 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018456
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018457ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018458 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018459 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018460 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18461 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018462
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018463ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18464 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18465 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18466 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018467 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018468
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018469ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18470 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18471 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018472 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18473 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018474
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018475ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18476 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18477 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18478 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018479 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018480
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018481ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18482 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018483 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18484 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018486ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18487 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18488 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18489 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18490 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18491 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018493ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18494 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18495 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18496 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18497 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018498
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018499ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018500 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18501 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18502 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018503 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018504 does not support resumed sessions.
18505
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018506ssl_c_der : binary
18507 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18508 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18509 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018511ssl_c_err : integer
18512 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18513 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18514 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18515 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18516 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018517
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018518ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018519 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18520 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18521 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18522 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18523 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18524 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18525 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18526 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018527 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18528 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18529 LDAP v3.
18530 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18531 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018533ssl_c_key_alg : string
18534 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18535 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18536 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018538ssl_c_notafter : string
18539 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18540 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18541 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018543ssl_c_notbefore : string
18544 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18545 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18546 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018547
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018548ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018549 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18550 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18551 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18552 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18553 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18554 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18555 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18556 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018557 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18558 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18559 LDAP v3.
18560 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18561 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018563ssl_c_serial : binary
18564 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18565 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18566 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018568ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18569 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18570 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18571 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018572 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18573 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18574
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018575 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018576 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018578ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18579 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18580 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18581 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018583ssl_c_used : boolean
18584 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18585 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018587ssl_c_verify : integer
18588 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18589 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18590 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18591 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018593ssl_c_version : integer
18594 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18595 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018596
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018597ssl_f_der : binary
18598 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18599 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18600 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18601
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018602ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018603 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18604 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18605 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18606 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018607 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018608 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18609 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18610 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018611 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18612 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18613 LDAP v3.
18614 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18615 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018617ssl_f_key_alg : string
18618 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18619 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18620 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018622ssl_f_notafter : string
18623 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18624 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18625 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018627ssl_f_notbefore : string
18628 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18629 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18630 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018631
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018632ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018633 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18634 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18635 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18636 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18637 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18638 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18639 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18640 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018641 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18642 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18643 LDAP v3.
18644 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18645 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018647ssl_f_serial : binary
18648 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18649 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18650 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018651
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018652ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18653 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18654 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18655 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018657ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18658 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18659 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18660 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018662ssl_f_version : integer
18663 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18664 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18665
18666ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018667 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18668 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18669 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018671 Example :
18672 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18673 listen http-https
18674 bind :80
18675 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18676 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18677
18678ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18679 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18680 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18681
18682ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018683 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018684 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018685 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018686 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18687 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18688 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18689 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18690 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18691 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693ssl_fc_cipher : string
18694 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18695 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018696
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018697ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18698 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18699 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018700 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018701
18702ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18703 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18704 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018705 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018706
18707ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18708 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18709 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18710 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018711 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018712 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018713
18714ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18715 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18716 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018717 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018718
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018719ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18720 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18721 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18722 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18723
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018724ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18725 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18726 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18727 transport layer.
18728 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18729 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18730 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18731 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18732
18733ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18734 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18735 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18736 transport layer.
18737 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18738 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18739 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18740 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18741
18742ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18743 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18744 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18745 transport layer.
18746 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18747 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18748 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18749 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18750
18751ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18752 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18753 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18754 transport layer.
18755 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18756 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18757 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18758 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18759
18760ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18761 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18762 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18763 transport layer.
18764 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18765 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18766 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18767 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018769ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018770 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18771 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018772 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18773 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18774 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18775 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018776
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018777ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18778 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18779 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18780 wait until the handshake happened.
18781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018782ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18783 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018784 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18785 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018786 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018787 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018788
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018789ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018790 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018791 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18792 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018794ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018795 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018796 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18798 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18799 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18800 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18801 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18802 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018804ssl_fc_protocol : string
18805 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18806 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018807
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018808ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018809 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018810 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018811 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018812
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018813ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18814 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18815 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18816 transport layer.
18817 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18818 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18819 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18820 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18821
18822ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18823 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18824 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18825 transport layer.
18826 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18827 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18828 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18829 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18830
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018831ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18832 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18833 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18834 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018836ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18837 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18838 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18839 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18840 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018841
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018842ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18843 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18844 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18845 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18846 BoringSSL.
18847
18848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018849ssl_fc_sni : string
18850 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18851 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018852 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018853 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18854 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18855
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018856 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018857 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018858 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018859 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018860 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018862 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018863 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18864 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018866ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18867 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18868 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018869
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018870ssl_s_der : binary
18871 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18872 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18873 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18874
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018875ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18876 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18877 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18878 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018879 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018880 does not support resumed sessions.
18881
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018882ssl_s_key_alg : string
18883 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18884 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18885 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18886
18887ssl_s_notafter : string
18888 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18889 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18890 transport layer.
18891
18892ssl_s_notbefore : string
18893 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18894 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18895 transport layer.
18896
18897ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18898 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18899 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18900 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18901 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18902 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18903 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018904 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18905 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018906 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18907 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18908 LDAP v3.
18909 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18910 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18911
18912ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18913 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18914 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18915 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18916 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18917 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18918 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018919 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18920 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018921 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18922 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18923 LDAP v3.
18924 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18925 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18926
18927ssl_s_serial : binary
18928 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18929 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18930 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18931
18932ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18933 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18934 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18935 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18936
18937ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18938 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18939 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18940 layer.
18941
18942ssl_s_version : integer
18943 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18944 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018945
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189467.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018947------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018949Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18950sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18951only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18952For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18953be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18954can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18955sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18956for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18957content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018958
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018959Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18960 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018961 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018962 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18963 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18964 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18965 sample expression). So be careful.
18966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018967payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018968 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018969 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18970 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018972payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18973 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018974 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018975 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018977req.len : integer
18978req_len : integer (deprecated)
18979 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18980 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18981 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18982 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18983 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018984 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018985 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18986 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018988req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18989 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018990 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18991 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18992 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18993 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018994
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018995 ACL derivatives :
18996 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018998req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18999 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19000 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19001 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19002 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019003
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019004 ACL derivatives :
19005 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019007 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019009req.proto_http : boolean
19010req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19011 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19012 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19013 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19014 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19015 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19016 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19017 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019019 Example:
19020 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19021 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19022 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019023 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019025req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19026rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19027 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19028 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19029 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19030 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19031 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19032 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19033 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019035 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19036 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19037 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19038 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19039 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19040 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019042 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019043 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019045 Example :
19046 listen tse-farm
19047 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19048 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19049 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19050 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19051 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19052 persist rdp-cookie
19053 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19054 # This is only useful makes sense if
19055 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19056 stick-table type string size 204800
19057 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19058 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19059 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019061 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019062 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019064req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19065rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19066 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19067 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19068 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19069 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019071 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019072 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019073
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019074req.ssl_alpn : string
19075 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19076 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19077 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19078 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19079 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19080 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019081 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019082
19083 Examples :
19084 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19085 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019086 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019087 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019088 default_backend bk_default
19089
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019090req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19091 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19092 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019093 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19094 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19095 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19096 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19097 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019099req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19100req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19101 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19102 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19103 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19104 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19105 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19106 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19107 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019109req.ssl_sni : string
19110req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19111 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19112 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19113 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19114 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19115 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019116 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19117 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19118 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19119 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19120 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19121 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19122 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19123 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19124 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019126 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019127 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019129 Examples :
19130 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19131 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019132 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019133 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019134 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019135
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019136req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19137 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19138 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19139 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19140 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19141 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19142 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19143 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19144 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19145 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019147req.ssl_ver : integer
19148req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19149 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19150 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19151 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19152 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19153 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19154 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19155 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019156 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019157 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019159 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019160 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019161
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019162res.len : integer
19163 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19164 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19165 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19166 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19167 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019168 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019169 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019170 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019172res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19173 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019174 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019175 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019176 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019177 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019179res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19180 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19181 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19182 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019183 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19184 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019186 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019187
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019188res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19189rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19190 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19191 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19192 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19193 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19194 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19195 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19196 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019198wait_end : boolean
19199 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19200 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019201 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019202 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19203 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019204 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019205 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19206 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019208 Examples :
19209 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19210 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19211 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019213 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19214 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19215 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19216 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19217 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19218 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19219 tcp-request content reject
19220
19221
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192227.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019223--------------------------------------
19224
19225It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19226This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19227data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19228its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19229HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19230content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19231to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19232more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19233response are indexed.
19234
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019235Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19236 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19237 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19238 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19239 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19240 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19241 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019243base : string
19244 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19245 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19246 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19247 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19248 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19249 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19250 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19251 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19252
19253 ACL derivatives :
19254 base : exact string match
19255 base_beg : prefix match
19256 base_dir : subdir match
19257 base_dom : domain match
19258 base_end : suffix match
19259 base_len : length match
19260 base_reg : regex match
19261 base_sub : substring match
19262
19263base32 : integer
19264 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19265 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19266 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019267 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19268 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19269 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019270
19271base32+src : binary
19272 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19273 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19274 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19275 per-URL counters.
19276
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019277baseq : string
19278 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19279 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19280 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19281 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19282
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019283capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19284 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19285 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19286 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19287
19288capture.req.method : string
19289 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19290 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19291 because it's allocated.
19292
19293capture.req.uri : string
19294 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19295 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19296 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19297 allocated.
19298
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019299capture.req.ver : string
19300 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19301 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19302 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19303
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019304capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19305 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19306 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19307 The first entry is an index of 0.
19308 See also: "capture response header"
19309
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019310capture.res.ver : string
19311 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19312 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19313 persistent flag.
19314
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019315req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019316 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19317 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19318 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019319
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019320req.body_param([<name>) : string
19321 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19322 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19323 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19324 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19325 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19326 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19327 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19328 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19329 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19330 given.
19331
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019332req.body_len : integer
19333 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19334 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019335 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19336 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019337
19338req.body_size : integer
19339 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019340 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19341 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019343req.cook([<name>]) : string
19344cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19345 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19346 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19347 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19348 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19349 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19350 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19351 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19352 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19353
19354 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019355 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19356 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19357 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19358 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19359 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19360 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19361 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19362 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019364req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19365cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19366 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19367 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019369req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19370cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19371 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19372 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19373 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19374 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019376cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19377 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19378 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19379 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19380 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019381 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019382 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19383 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19384 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19385 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019387hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19388 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19389 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19390 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19391 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019392 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019394req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019395 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19396 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19397 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19398 with headers such as User-Agent.
19399
19400 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19401 found.
19402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019403 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19404 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19405 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019406 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019408req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19409 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19410 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019411 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19412 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019414req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019415 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19416 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19417 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19418 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19419 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19420 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19421 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19422
19423 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19424 found.
19425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019426 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19427 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19428 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019429 with -1 being the last one.
19430
19431 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19432 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019434 ACL derivatives :
19435 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19436 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19437 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19438 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19439 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19440 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19441 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19442 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19443
19444req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19445hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19446 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19447 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019448 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19449 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19450 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19451
19452 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19453 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19454 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19455
19456 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019457
19458req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19459hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19460 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19461 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19462 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019463 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19464 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19465 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19466 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19467 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019468
19469 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19470
19471 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019472
19473req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19474hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19475 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19476 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19477 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019478
19479 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19480
19481 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019482
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019483req.hdrs : string
19484 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19485 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19486 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19487 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19488
19489req.hdrs_bin : binary
19490 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19491 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19492 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19493 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19494 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19495 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19496
19497 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019498
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019499 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19500 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019502http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19503 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19504 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19505 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19506 basic auth is supported.
19507
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019508http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19509 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19510 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19511 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19512 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019513 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19514 basic auth is supported.
19515
19516 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019517 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19518 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19519 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19520 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019521
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019522http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019523 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19524 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19525 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019526
19527http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019528 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19529 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19530 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019531
19532http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019533 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19534 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19535 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019537http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019538 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19539 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019540 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19541 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019543method : integer + string
19544 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19545 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19546 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19547 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19548 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19549 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19550 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019552 ACL derivatives :
19553 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019555 Example :
19556 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19557 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19558 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019560path : string
19561 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19562 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19563 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19564 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19565 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019566 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019567 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019569 ACL derivatives :
19570 path : exact string match
19571 path_beg : prefix match
19572 path_dir : subdir match
19573 path_dom : domain match
19574 path_end : suffix match
19575 path_len : length match
19576 path_reg : regex match
19577 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019578
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019579pathq : string
19580 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19581 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19582 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19583 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19584 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19585 result in both cases.
19586
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019587query : string
19588 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19589 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19590 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19591 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019592 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019593 which stops before the question mark.
19594
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019595req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19596 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19597 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19598 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19599 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019601req.ver : string
19602req_ver : string (deprecated)
19603 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19604 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19605 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019607 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019608 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019609
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019610res.body : binary
19611 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19612 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019613 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19614
19615 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019616
19617res.body_len : integer
19618 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19619 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019620 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19621
19622 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019623
19624res.body_size : integer
19625 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19626 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19627 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19628 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019629 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19630
19631 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019632
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019633res.cache_hit : boolean
19634 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19635 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19636
19637res.cache_name : string
19638 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19639 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19640 empty string.
19641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019642res.comp : boolean
19643 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19644 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19645 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019647res.comp_algo : string
19648 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19649 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19650 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019652res.cook([<name>]) : string
19653scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19654 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19655 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019656 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19657
19658 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019660 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019661 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019663res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19664scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19665 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19666 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019667 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19668
19669 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019671res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19672scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19673 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19674 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019675 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19676
19677 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019679res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019680 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19681 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19682
19683 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19684 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19685
19686 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19687
19688 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019690res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019691 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19692 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19693
19694 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19695 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19696
19697 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019699res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19700shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019701 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19702 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19703
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019704 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019705 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19706
19707 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019709 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019710 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19711 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19712 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19713 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19714 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19715 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19716 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19717 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019718
19719res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19720shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019721 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19722 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19723
19724 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019725 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019726
19727 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019729res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19730shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019731 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19732 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19733
19734 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19735
19736 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019737
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019738res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19739 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19740 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19741 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019742 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19743
19744 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019746res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19747shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019748 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19749 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19750
19751 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19752
19753 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019754
19755res.hdrs : string
19756 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19757 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19758 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019759 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19760
19761 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019762
19763res.hdrs_bin : binary
19764 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19765 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19766 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19767 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19768 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19769 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19770 (length of 0 for both).
19771
19772 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19773
19774 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19775 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019777res.ver : string
19778resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19779 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019780 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19781
19782 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019784 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019785 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019787set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19788 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19789 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019790 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019791 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019793 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19794 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019796status : integer
19797 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19798 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019799 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19800
19801 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019802
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019803unique-id : string
19804 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19805 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19806 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19807 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19808 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19809 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019811url : string
19812 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19813 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19814 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19815 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19816 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19817 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19818 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019820 ACL derivatives :
19821 url : exact string match
19822 url_beg : prefix match
19823 url_dir : subdir match
19824 url_dom : domain match
19825 url_end : suffix match
19826 url_len : length match
19827 url_reg : regex match
19828 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019830url_ip : ip
19831 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19832 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19833 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19834 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19835 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19836 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19837 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019839url_port : integer
19840 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19841 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19842 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19843 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019844
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019845urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19846url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019847 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19848 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019849 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19850 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19851 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19852 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019853 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19854 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019855 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19856 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019858 ACL derivatives :
19859 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19860 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19861 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19862 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19863 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19864 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19865 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19866 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019867
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019869 Example :
19870 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19871 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19872 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19873 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019874
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019875urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019876 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19877 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19878 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019879
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019880url32 : integer
19881 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19882 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19883 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19884 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19885 is an unsigned integer.
19886
19887url32+src : binary
19888 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19889 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19890 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19891
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019892
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200198937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019894---------------------------------------
19895
19896This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19897used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19898purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19899There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19900or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19901any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19902for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19903
19904internal.htx.data : integer
19905 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19906 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19907
19908internal.htx.free : integer
19909 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19910 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19911
19912internal.htx.free_data : integer
19913 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19914 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19915
19916internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019917 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19918 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19919 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019920
19921internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19922 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19923 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19924
19925internal.htx.size : integer
19926 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19927 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19928
19929internal.htx.used : integer
19930 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19931 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19932 direction.
19933
19934internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19935 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19936 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19937 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19938 of the special value :
19939 * head : The oldest inserted block
19940 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019941 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019942
19943internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19944 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19945 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19946 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19947 integer or one of the special value :
19948 * head : The oldest inserted block
19949 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019950 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019951
19952internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19953 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19954 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19955 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19956 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19957
19958 * head : The oldest inserted block
19959 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019960 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019961
19962internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19963 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19964 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19965 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19966 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19967
19968 * head : The oldest inserted block
19969 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019970 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019971
19972internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19973 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19974 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19975 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19976 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19977
19978 * head : The oldest inserted block
19979 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019980 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019981
19982internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19983 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19984 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19985 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19986 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19987
19988 * head : The oldest inserted block
19989 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019990 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019991
19992internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19993 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19994 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19995 it returns false.
19996
19997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200199987.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019999---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020001Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20002every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020003order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020005ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020006---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20007FALSE always_false never match
20008HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20009HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20010HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020011HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020012HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20013HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20014HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20015HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20016LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20017METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20018METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20019METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20020METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20021METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20022METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20023METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20024METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20025RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20026REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20027TRUE always_true always match
20028WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20029---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020030
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200328. Logging
20033----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020034
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020035One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20036provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20037very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20038provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20039state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020040to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020041headers.
20042
20043In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20044about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20045send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20046
20047 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20048 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20049 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20050 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20051 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020052 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020053 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020054
20055The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20056allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20057as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20058while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20059real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20060delay.
20061
20062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200638.1. Log levels
20064---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020065
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020066TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020067source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020068HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20069in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20070track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20071syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20072about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020073
20074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200758.2. Log formats
20076----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020077
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020078HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020079and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20080slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20081options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020082
20083 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20084 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20085 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20086 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20087 extents.
20088
20089 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20090 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20091 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20092 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20093 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20094
20095 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20096 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20097 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20098 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20099 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20100
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020101 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20102 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20103 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20104 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20105
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020106 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20107
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020108Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20109specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20110field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20111servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20112always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20113identifier.
20114
20115Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20116 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20117 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20118 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20119 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20120
20121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201228.2.1. Default log format
20123-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020124
20125This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20126as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20127format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20128
20129 Example :
20130 listen www
20131 mode http
20132 log global
20133 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20134
20135 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20136 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20137 (www/HTTP)
20138
20139 Field Format Extract from the example above
20140 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20141 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20142 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20143 4 'to' to
20144 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20145 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20146
20147Detailed fields description :
20148 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20149 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20150 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20151 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20152 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20153 and processed the connection.
20154 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20155
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020156In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20157"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20158connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20159
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020160It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20161will eventually disappear.
20162
20163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201648.2.2. TCP log format
20165---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020166
20167The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20168is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20169information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20170counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20171emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20172environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20173the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20174sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020175specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20176not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20177fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20178marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020179
20180 Example :
20181 frontend fnt
20182 mode tcp
20183 option tcplog
20184 log global
20185 default_backend bck
20186
20187 backend bck
20188 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20189
20190 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20191 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20192 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20193
20194 Field Format Extract from the example above
20195 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20196 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20197 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20198 4 frontend_name fnt
20199 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20200 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20201 7 bytes_read* 212
20202 8 termination_state --
20203 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20204 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20205
20206Detailed fields description :
20207 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020208 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020209 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20210 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020211 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020212 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020213 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020214
20215 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020216 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20217 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20218 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020219
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020220 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020221 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20222 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020223 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20224 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20225 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20226 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020227
20228 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20229 and processed the connection.
20230
20231 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20232 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20233 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20234 applications.
20235
20236 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20237 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20238 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20239 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20240 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20241
20242 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20243 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20244 See "Timers" below for more details.
20245
20246 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20247 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20248 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20249 "Timers" below for more details.
20250
20251 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020252 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020253 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20254 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20255 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20256 details.
20257
20258 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20259 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20260 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20261 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20262 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20263
20264 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20265 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20266 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20267 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20268 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20269 for more details.
20270
20271 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020272 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020273 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20274 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20275 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020276 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020277
20278 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20279 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20280 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20281 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20282 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20283 caused by a denial of service attack.
20284
20285 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20286 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20287 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20288 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20289 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20290 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20291 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20292 denial of service attack.
20293
20294 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20295 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20296 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20297 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20298 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20299 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20300 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20301 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20302 be processed than on other servers.
20303
20304 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20305 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20306 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20307 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020308 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020309 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20310 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20311 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20312 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20313 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20314 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20315 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20316 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20317
20318 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20319 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20320 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20321 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20322 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20323 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020324 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020325 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20326
20327 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20328 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20329 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20330 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20331 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20332 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020333 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020334 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20335 occurs.
20336
20337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203388.2.3. HTTP log format
20339----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020340
20341The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20342is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20343the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20344are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20345emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20346generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20347"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20348which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020349frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20350is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020351
20352Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20353slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20354with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20355
20356 Example :
20357 frontend http-in
20358 mode http
20359 option httplog
20360 log global
20361 default_backend bck
20362
20363 backend static
20364 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20365
20366 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20367 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20368 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020369 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020370
20371 Field Format Extract from the example above
20372 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20373 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020374 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020375 4 frontend_name http-in
20376 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020377 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020378 7 status_code 200
20379 8 bytes_read* 2750
20380 9 captured_request_cookie -
20381 10 captured_response_cookie -
20382 11 termination_state ----
20383 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20384 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20385 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20386 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20387 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020388
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020389Detailed fields description :
20390 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020391 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020392 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20393 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020394 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020395 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020396 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020397
20398 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020399 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20400 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20401 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020402
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020403 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020404 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020405
20406 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20407 and processed the connection.
20408
20409 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20410 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20411 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20412
20413 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20414 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20415 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20416 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20417 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20418 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20419
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020420 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20421 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20422 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020423 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020424 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20425 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020426 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020427 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020428
20429 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20430 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020431 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020432
20433 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20434 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020435 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20436 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020437
20438 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20439 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20440 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20441 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20442 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020443 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20444 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020445
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020446 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020447 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20448 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20449 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20450 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20451 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20452 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020453 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020454
20455 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020456 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20457 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020458
20459 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20460 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020461 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020462 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20463 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20464 overflowing.
20465
20466 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20467 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20468 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20469 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20470 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20471 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20472 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20473 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20474
20475 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20476 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20477 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20478 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20479 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20480 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20481 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20482 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20483
20484 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20485 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20486 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20487 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20488 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20489 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20490 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20491
20492 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020493 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020494 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20495 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20496 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020497 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020498 system.
20499
20500 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20501 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20502 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20503 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20504 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20505 caused by a denial of service attack.
20506
20507 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20508 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20509 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20510 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20511 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20512 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20513 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20514 denial of service attack.
20515
20516 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20517 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20518 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20519 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20520 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20521 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20522 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20523 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20524 processed than on other servers.
20525
20526 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20527 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20528 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20529 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020530 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020531 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20532 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20533 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20534 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20535 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20536 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20537 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20538 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20539
20540 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20541 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20542 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20543 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20544 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20545 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020546 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020547 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20548
20549 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20550 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20551 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20552 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20553 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20554 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020555 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020556 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20557 occurs.
20558
20559 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20560 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20561 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20562 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20563 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20564 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20565 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20566 cookies" below for more details.
20567
20568 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20569 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20570 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20571 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20572 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20573 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20574 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20575 and cookies" below for more details.
20576
20577 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20578 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20579 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20580 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20581 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20582 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20583 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20584 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20585
20586
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200205878.2.4. Custom log format
20588------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020589
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020590The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020591mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020592
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020593HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020594Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20595separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20596prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20597
20598Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20599variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020600("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020601
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020602If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020603as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020604less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20605the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20606
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020607Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20608"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20609delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20610preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020611
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020612Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20613'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20614https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20615such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20616
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020617Flags are :
20618 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020619 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020620 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20621 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020622
20623 Example:
20624
20625 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20626 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20627
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020628 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20629
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020630At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20631
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020632 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20633 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020634
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020635the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020636
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020637 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20638 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20639 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020640
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020641and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20642
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020643 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20644 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020645
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020646Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20647
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020648 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020649 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020650 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20651 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20652 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020653 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20654 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20655 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020656 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020657 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020658 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020659 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020660 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020661 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20662 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020663 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020664 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020665 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020666 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020667 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020668 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020669 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020670 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20671 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20672 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20673 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20674 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020675 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020676 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020677 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020678 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020679 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020680 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20681 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020682 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20683 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20684 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020685 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020686 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20687 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020688 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020689 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20690 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20691 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020692 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020693 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020694 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20695 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20696 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20697 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020698 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020699 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020700 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020701 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020702 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020703 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020704 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20705 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20706 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020707 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020708 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20709 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020710 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020711 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20712 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020713 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020714 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020715 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020716 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020717
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020718 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020719
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020720
207218.2.5. Error log format
20722-----------------------
20723
20724When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020725protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020726By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20727"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020728will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020729logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20730
20731The format looks like this :
20732
20733 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20734 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20735 Connection error during SSL handshake
20736
20737 Field Format Extract from the example above
20738 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20739 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20740 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20741 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20742 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20743
20744These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20745failures.
20746
20747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207488.3. Advanced logging options
20749-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020750
20751Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20752just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20753options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20754for more information about their usage.
20755
20756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207578.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20758------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020759
20760It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020761HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020762commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20763monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20764ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20765
20766 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20767 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20768 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20769 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20770
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020771 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20772 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020773
20774 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20775 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20776 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20777
20778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207798.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20780----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020781
20782The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20783what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20784or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020785"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020786just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20787log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20788after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20789is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20790with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20791with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20792
20793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207948.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20795------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020796
20797Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20798for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20799"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20800retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20801raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20802a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20803file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20804you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20805"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20806
20807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20809--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020810
20811Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20812multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20813them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20814"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20815logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20816error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20817and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20818too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20819useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20820alternative.
20821
20822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208238.4. Timing events
20824------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020825
20826Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20827reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20828the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20829frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020830mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20831addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20832
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020833Timings events in HTTP mode:
20834
20835 first request 2nd request
20836 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20837 t tr t tr ...
20838 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20839 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20840 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20841 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020842 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020843 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20844
20845Timings events in TCP mode:
20846
20847 TCP session
20848 |<----------------->|
20849 t t
20850 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20851 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20852 |<------ Tt ------->|
20853
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020854 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020855 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020856 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20857 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20858 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020859 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020860 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20861 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20862 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20863 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020864
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020865 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20866 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20867 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020868 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20869 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20870 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20871 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20872 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20873 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020874
20875 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20876 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20877 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20878 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20879 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20880 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20881 request typed by hand during a test.
20882
20883 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20884 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020885 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020886 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20887 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20888 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20889 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020890
20891 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20892 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20893 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20894 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20895 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20896
20897 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20898 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20899 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20900 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20901 connection never established.
20902
20903 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20904 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20905 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20906 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20907 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20908 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20909 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20910 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20911 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20912 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20913 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20914
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020915 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20916 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20917 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20918 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20919 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20920 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20921
20922 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20923
20924 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20925 "Ta" can never be negative.
20926
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020927 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20928 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020929 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20930 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020931 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020932
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020933 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020934
20935 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020936 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20937 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020938
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020939 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20940 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20941 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20942 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20943 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20944 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20945 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20946 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20947
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020948These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20949protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20950that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020951due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20952"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20953that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020954
20955Most common cases :
20956
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020957 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20958 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20959 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20960 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20961 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020962 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020963 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20964 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20965 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20966 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20967 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020968 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020969
20970 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20971 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20972 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20973 of ms on remote networks.
20974
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020975 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20976 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20977 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020978
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020979 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20980 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020981 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020982 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20983 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20984 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20985 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20986 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20987 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020988
20989Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20990
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020991 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020992 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020993 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020994
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020995 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020996 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20997 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20998
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020999 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021000 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21001 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21002 flags.
21003
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021004 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21005 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021006 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21007 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21008 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21009 the client connection was maintained open.
21010
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021011 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021012 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021013 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021014 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21015
21016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210178.5. Session state at disconnection
21018-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021019
21020TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21021"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
210222-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21023each of which has a special meaning :
21024
21025 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21026 session to terminate :
21027
21028 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21029
21030 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21031 server explicitly refused it.
21032
21033 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21034 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21035 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21036 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021037 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021038
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021039 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021040 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021041
21042 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21043 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21044 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21045 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21046 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21047
21048 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21049 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21050 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21051 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21052 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21053
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021054 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021055 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21056
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021057 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021058 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21059 backup connections when going up.
21060
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021061 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021062
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021063 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21064 send or receive data.
21065
21066 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21067 send or receive data.
21068
21069 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21070 with nothing left in the buffers.
21071
21072 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21073
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021074 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021075 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21076
21077 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21078 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21079 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21080 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21081 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21082
21083 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21084 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21085
21086 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21087 server (HTTP only).
21088
21089 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21090
21091 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21092 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21093 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21094
21095 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21096 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21097 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21098
21099 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21100
21101 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21102 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21103
21104 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21105 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21106 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21107
21108 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21109 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021110 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21111 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021112
21113 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21114 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21115 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21116 another server.
21117
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021118 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021119 server.
21120
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021121 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21122 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21123 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21124 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21125
21126 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21127 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21128 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21129 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21130
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021131 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21132 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21133 "use-server" rule).
21134
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021135 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21136
21137 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21138 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21139
21140 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21141
21142 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21143 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21144 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21145
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021146 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21147 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021148 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021149 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21150 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21151
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021152 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21153
21154 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21155 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21156
21157 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21158
21159 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21160
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021161The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21162was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021163helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21164starvation, attacks, etc...
21165
21166The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21167alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21168easier finding and understanding.
21169
21170 Flags Reason
21171
21172 -- Normal termination.
21173
21174 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021175 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21176 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021177 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21178
21179 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21180 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021181 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21182 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021183 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21184 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021185
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021186 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21187 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021188 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021189
21190 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21191 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21192 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21193
21194 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21195 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21196 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21197 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21198 the server takes too long to respond.
21199
21200 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21201 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21202 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21203 long a time to respond.
21204
21205 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21206 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21207 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021208 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021209 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21210 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021211
21212 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21213 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21214 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21215 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21216 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021217 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021218 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21219 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21220 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21221 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21222 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21223 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21224 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21225 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021226 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021227 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21228 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21229 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021230
21231 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21232 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021233 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21234 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21235 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21236 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021237
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021238 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021239 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21240
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021241 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021242 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21243 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021244 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021245 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21246 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21247
21248 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21249 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21250 503 or 504 here.
21251
21252 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021253 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021254 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21255 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21256 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21257
21258 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21259 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021260 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021261 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021262 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021263
21264 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21265 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21266 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21267 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21268 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21269 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021270 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021271
21272 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21273 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21274 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21275 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21276 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21277 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21278 solution is to fix the application.
21279
21280 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21281 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21282 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21283 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21284 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21285 external attacks.
21286
21287 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021288 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021289 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021290 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21291 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21292
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021293 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21294 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21295 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021296 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021297 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021298
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021299 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21300 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21301 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21302 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021303 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21304 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21305 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21306 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021307 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21308 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21309 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21310 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021311
21312 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21313 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21314 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021315 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21316 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21317 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21318 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021319
21320 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21321 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21322 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21323 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21324
21325 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21326 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21327 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21328 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21329
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021330The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021331persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021332important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21333re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21334
21335 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21336
21337 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21338 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21339 set on a GET request.
21340
21341 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21342 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021343 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021344 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21345
21346 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21347 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21348 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21349
21350 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21351 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21352 already got a cookie.
21353
21354 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21355 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21356 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21357 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21358 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21359
21360 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21361 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21362 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21363
21364 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21365 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21366 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21367
21368 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21369 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21370
21371 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21372 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21373 then advertised in the response.
21374
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213768.6. Non-printable characters
21377-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021378
21379In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21380consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21381converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21382prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21383being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21384escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21385is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21386'}' when logging headers.
21387
21388Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21389issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21390containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21391
21392Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21393the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21394performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21395
21396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213978.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21398---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021399
21400Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21401achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021402section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021403cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21404the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21405the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021406locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021407not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21408user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21409a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21410wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21411
21412 Examples :
21413 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21414 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21415
21416 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21417 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21418
21419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214208.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21421---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021422
21423Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21424proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21425the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21426server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21427
21428Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21429response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021430section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021431
21432It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021433time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21434appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021435are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21436and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21437follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21438request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21439in the logs.
21440
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021441As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21442frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21443an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21444
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021445 Example :
21446 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21447 listen proxy-out
21448 mode http
21449 option httplog
21450 option logasap
21451 log global
21452 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21453
21454 # log the name of the virtual server
21455 capture request header Host len 20
21456
21457 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21458 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21459
21460 # log the beginning of the referrer
21461 capture request header Referer len 20
21462
21463 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21464 capture response header Server len 20
21465
21466 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21467 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21468
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021469 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021470 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21471
21472 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21473 capture response header Via len 20
21474
21475 # log the URL location during a redirection
21476 capture response header Location len 20
21477
21478 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21479 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21480 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21481 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21482 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21483
21484 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21485 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21486 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21487 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021488 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021489
21490 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21491 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21492 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21493 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21494 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021495 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021496
21497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214988.9. Examples of logs
21499---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021500
21501These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21502them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21503reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21504
21505 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21506 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21507 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21508
21509 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21510 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21511
21512 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21513 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21514 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21515
21516 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21517 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21518
21519 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21520 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21521 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21522
21523 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021524 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021525 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21526 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21527
21528 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21529 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21530 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21531
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021532 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21533 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21534 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21535 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021536 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021537 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021538
21539 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021540 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021541
21542 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21543 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21544 Nothing was sent to any server.
21545
21546 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21547 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21548
21549 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21550 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021551 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021552 send a 408 return code to the client.
21553
21554 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21555 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21556
21557 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21558 5 seconds ("c----").
21559
21560 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21561 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021562 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021563
21564 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021565 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021566 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21567 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21568 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21569 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21570 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021571
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021572
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200215739. Supported filters
21574--------------------
21575
21576Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21577accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21578unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21579
21580See also : "filter"
21581
215829.1. Trace
21583----------
21584
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021585filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021586
21587 Arguments:
21588 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21589 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21590
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021591 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021592
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021593 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021594 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21595 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21596 amount of the parsed data.
21597
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021598 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021599
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021600This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21601callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21602information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21603filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21604
21605Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21606tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21607a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21608
21609
216109.2. HTTP compression
21611---------------------
21612
21613filter compression
21614
21615The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21616keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021617when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21618fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21619done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21620explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21621filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21622listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21623order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021624
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021625See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21626 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021627
21628
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200216299.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21630--------------------------------------------
21631
21632filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21633
21634 Arguments :
21635
21636 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21637 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21638 parsed.
21639
21640 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21641 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21642 part must be placed in its own scope.
21643
21644The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21645external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021646streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021647exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21648also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21649
21650SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21651the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21652
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021653For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021654"doc/SPOE.txt".
21655
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100216569.4. Cache
21657----------
21658
21659filter cache <name>
21660
21661 Arguments :
21662
21663 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21664
21665The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21666"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021667cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021668other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21669case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21670is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21671filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021672listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21673order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021674
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021675See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21676 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21677
21678
216799.5. Fcgi-app
21680-------------
21681
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021682filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021683
21684 Arguments :
21685
21686 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21687
21688The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21689request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21690reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21691used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21692implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21693used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21694fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21695used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21696order.
21697
21698See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21699 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21700
21701
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100217029.6. OpenTracing
21703----------------
21704
21705The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21706HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21707of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21708Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21709
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021710This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021711
21712The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21713HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21714participates in the work of HAProxy.
21715
21716filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21717
21718 Arguments :
21719
21720 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21721 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21722 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21723 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21724 OpenTracing filters.
21725
21726 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21727 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21728 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21729 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21730 filter must have its own scope defined.
21731
21732More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021733of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021734
21735
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002173610. FastCGI applications
21737-------------------------
21738
21739HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21740feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21741the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21742FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21743servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21744FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21745backend.
21746
21747HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21748application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21749connection.
21750
2175110.1. Setup
21752-----------
21753
2175410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21755--------------------------
21756
21757fcgi-app <name>
21758 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21759 document root must be defined.
21760
21761acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21762 Declare or complete an access list.
21763
21764 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21765 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21766 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21767 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21768 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21769
21770docroot <path>
21771 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21772 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21773 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21774
21775index <script-name>
21776 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21777 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21778 is an optional setting.
21779
21780 Example :
21781 index index.php
21782
21783log-stderr global
21784log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021785 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021786 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21787
21788 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21789 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21790
21791pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21792 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21793 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21794 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21795
21796 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21797 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21798 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21799 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21800
21801 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21802 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21803
21804path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021805 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021806 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21807 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21808 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21809 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21810 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21811 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21812 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021813
21814 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021815 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021816 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21817 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21818 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21819 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021820
21821 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021822 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21823 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021824
21825option get-values
21826no option get-values
21827 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21828
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021829 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021830 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21831
21832 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21833 application will accept.
21834
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021835 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21836 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021837
21838 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021839 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021840 option is disabled.
21841
21842 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21843 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21844 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21845 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21846 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21847 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21848
21849option keep-conn
21850no option keep-conn
21851 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21852 sending a response.
21853
21854 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21855 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21856
21857option max-reqs <reqs>
21858 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21859 accept.
21860
21861 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21862 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21863 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21864 to 1.
21865
21866option mpxs-conns
21867no option mpxs-conns
21868 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21869
21870 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21871 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21872
21873set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21874 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21875 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21876 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21877 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21878
21879 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21880 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21881 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21882
21883 Example :
21884 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21885 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21886
21887 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21888
21889
2189010.1.2. Proxy section
21891---------------------
21892
21893use-fcgi-app <name>
21894 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21895
21896 Arguments :
21897 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21898
21899 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21900 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21901 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21902 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21903 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21904
21905 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21906 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21907 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21908 application are evaluated.
21909
21910
2191110.1.3. Example
21912---------------
21913
21914 frontend front-http
21915 mode http
21916 bind *:80
21917 bind *:
21918
21919 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21920 default_backend back-static
21921
21922 backend back-static
21923 mode http
21924 server www A.B.C.D:80
21925
21926 backend back-dynamic
21927 mode http
21928 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21929 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21930
21931 fcgi-app php-fpm
21932 log-stderr global
21933 option keep-conn
21934
21935 docroot /var/www/my-app
21936 index index.php
21937 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21938
21939
2194010.2. Default parameters
21941------------------------
21942
21943A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21944the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021945script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021946applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21947
21948 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21949 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21950 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21951 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21952 | | |
21953 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21954 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21955 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21956 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21957 | | application. |
21958 | | |
21959 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21960 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21961 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21962 | | |
21963 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21964 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21965 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21966 | | the application's configuration. |
21967 | | |
21968 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21969 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21970 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21971 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21972 | | |
21973 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21974 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21975 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21976 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21977 | | be defined. |
21978 | | |
21979 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21980 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21981 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21982 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21983 | | is not set too. |
21984 | | |
21985 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21986 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21987 | | set. |
21988 | | |
21989 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21990 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21991 | | the request. |
21992 | | |
21993 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21994 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21995 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21996 | | |
21997 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21998 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21999 | | script to process the request. |
22000 | | |
22001 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22002 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22003 | | |
22004 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22005 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22006 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22007 | | |
22008 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22009 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22010 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22011 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22012 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22013 | | |
22014 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22015 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22016 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22017 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22018 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22019 | | side. |
22020 | | |
22021 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22022 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22023 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22024 | | connected to. |
22025 | | |
22026 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22027 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22028 | | |
22029 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022030 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22031 | | current HAProxy version. |
22032 | | |
22033 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022034 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22035 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22036 | | |
22037 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22038
22039
2204010.3. Limitations
22041------------------
22042
22043The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22044way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22045during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22046establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22047application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22048or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22049message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22050these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22051and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22052
22053Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22054request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22055requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22056
22057About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22058into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22059fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22060"http-request" ones.
22061
22062Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22063FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22064processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22065must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22066here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022067
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022068
2206911. Address formats
22070-------------------
22071
22072Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22073address.
22074
22075This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22076The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22077of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22078equivalent is '::'.
22079
22080Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22081is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22082
22083This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22084family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22085
22086Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22087configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22088use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22089'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22090
22091Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22092socket type and the transport method.
22093
22094
2209511.1 Address family prefixes
22096----------------------------
22097
22098'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22099
22100'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22101 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22102 listening.
22103
22104'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22105 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22106 on the statement using this address, a port or
22107 a port range may or must be specified.
22108
22109'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22110 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22111 using this address, a port or a port range
22112 may or must be specified.
22113
22114'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22115 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22116 using this address, a port or a port range
22117 may or must be specified.
22118
22119'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22120 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22121 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22122 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22123 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22124 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22125
22126'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22127 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22128 start by slash '/'.
22129
22130
2213111.2 Socket type prefixes
22132-------------------------
22133
22134Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22135type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22136this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22137This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22138but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22139
22140Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22141instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22142
22143If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22144they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22145report this to the maintainers.
22146
22147'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22148 to "stream"
22149
22150'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22151 to "datagram".
22152
22153
2215411.3 Protocol prefixes
22155----------------------
22156
22157'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22158 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22159 socket type and transport method is forced to
22160 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22161 this address, a port or a port range can or
22162 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22163 of 'stream+ip@'.
22164
22165'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22166 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22167 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22168 statement using this address, a port or port
22169 range can or must be specified.
22170 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22171
22172'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22173 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22174 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22175 statement using this address, a port or port
22176 range can or must be specified.
22177 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22178
22179'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22180 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22181 socket type and transport method is forced to
22182 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22183 this address, a port or a port range can or
22184 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22185 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22186
22187'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22188 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22189 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22190 the statement using this address, a port or
22191 port range can or must be specified.
22192 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22193
22194'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22195 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22196 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22197 the statement using this address, a port or
22198 port range can or must be specified.
22199 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22200
22201'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22202 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22203 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22204
22205'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22206 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22207 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22208
22209In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22210QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22211
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022212/*
22213 * Local variables:
22214 * fill-column: 79
22215 * End:
22216 */